Index: ChangeLog
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
56
57 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
58 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
59 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
60 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
61 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
62 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
63
64 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
65 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
66 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
67 development.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
88 @sp 2
89 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
90 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
92 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
93
94 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
97 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
100
101 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104 development.''
105 @end titlepage
106 @page
107
108 @ifnottex
109 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
111 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
115 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
116 @value{GDBVN}.
117
118 Copyright (C) 1988-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
119
120 @menu
121 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128 * Stack:: Examining the stack
129 * Source:: Examining source files
130 * Data:: Examining data
131 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
132 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
133 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
134
135 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
136
137 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138 * Altering:: Altering execution
139 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
141 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
142 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
145 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
146 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
147 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
148 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
149 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
150
151 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
152 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
153
154 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
155 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
156 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
157 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
158 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
159 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
160 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
161 how you can copy and share GDB
162 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
163 * Index:: Index
164 @end menu
165
166 @end ifnottex
167
168 @contents
169
170 @node Summary
171 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
172
173 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
174 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
175 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
176
177 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
178 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
179
180 @itemize @bullet
181 @item
182 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
183
184 @item
185 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
186
187 @item
188 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
189
190 @item
191 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
192 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
193 @end itemize
194
195 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
196 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
197 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
198
199 @cindex Modula-2
200 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
201 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
202
203 @cindex Pascal
204 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
205 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
206 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
207 syntax.
208
209 @cindex Fortran
210 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
211 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
212 underscore.
213
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
215 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
216
217 @menu
218 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
219 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
220 @end menu
221
222 @node Free Software
223 @unnumberedsec Free software
224
225 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
226 General Public License
227 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
228 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
229 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
230 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
231 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
232 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
233
234 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
235 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
236 from anyone else.
237
238 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
239
240 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
241 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
242 include with the free software. Many of our most important
243 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
244 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
245 when an important free software package does not come with a free
246 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
247 gaps today.
248
249 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
250 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
251 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
252 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
253 them from the free software world.
254
255 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
256 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
257 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
258 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
259 contract to make it non-free.
260
261 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
262 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
263 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
264 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
265 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
266 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
267 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
268
269 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
270 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
271 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
272 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
273
274 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
275 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
276 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
277 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
278 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
279 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
280 community.
281
282 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
283 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
284 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
285 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
286 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
287 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
288 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
289 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
290 of the manual.
291
292 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
293 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
294 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
295 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
296 manual to replace it.
297
298 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
299 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
300 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
301 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
302 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
303 the free software community.
304
305 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
306 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
307 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
308 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
309 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
310 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
311 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
312 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
313 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
314
315 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
316 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
317 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
318 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
319 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
320 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
321 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
322 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
323
324 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
325 published by other publishers, at
326 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
327
328 @node Contributors
329 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
330
331 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
332 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
333 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
334 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
335 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
336 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
337 blow-by-blow account.
338
339 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
340
341 @quotation
342 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
343 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
344 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
345 @end quotation
346
347 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
348 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
349 releases:
350 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
351 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
352 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
353 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
354 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
355 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
356 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
357 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
358 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
359
360 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
361 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
362
363 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
364 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
365 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
366 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
367 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
368
369 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
370 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
371 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
372
373 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
374 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
375
376 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
377
378 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
379 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
380 support.
381 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
382 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
383 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
384 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
385 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
386 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
387 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
388 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
389 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
390 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
391 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
392 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
393 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
394 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
395 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
396 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
397
398 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
399
400 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
401 libraries.
402
403 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
404 about several machine instruction sets.
405
406 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
407 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
408 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
409 and RDI targets, respectively.
410
411 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
412 command-line editing and command history.
413
414 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
415 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
416
417 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
418 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
419 symbols.
420
421 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
422 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
423
424 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
425
426 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
427 processors.
428
429 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
430
431 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
432
433 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
434
435 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
436 watchpoints.
437
438 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
439
440 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
441
442 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
443 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
444
445 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
446 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
447 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
448 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
449 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
450 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
451 information in this manual.
452
453 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
454 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
455
456 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
457 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
458 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
459 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
460 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
461 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
462 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
463 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
464 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
465 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
466 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
467 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
468 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
469 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
470 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
471
472 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
473 Hat.
474
475 @node Sample Session
476 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
477
478 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
479 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
480 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
481
482 @iftex
483 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
484 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
485 @end iftex
486
487 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
488 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
489
490 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
491 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
492 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
493 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
494 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
495 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
496 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
497 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
498 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
499
500 @smallexample
501 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
502 $ @b{./m4}
503 @b{define(foo,0000)}
504
505 @b{foo}
506 0000
507 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
508
509 @b{bar}
510 0000
511 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
512
513 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
514 @b{baz}
515 @b{C-d}
516 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
517 @end smallexample
518
519 @noindent
520 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
521
522 @smallexample
523 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
524 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
525 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
526 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
527 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
528 the conditions.
529 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
530 for details.
531
532 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
533 (@value{GDBP})
534 @end smallexample
535
536 @noindent
537 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
538 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
539 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
540 that examples fit in this manual.
541
542 @smallexample
543 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
544 @end smallexample
545
546 @noindent
547 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
548 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
549 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
550 @code{break} command.
551
552 @smallexample
553 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
554 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
559 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
560 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
561
562 @smallexample
563 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
564 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
565 @b{define(foo,0000)}
566
567 @b{foo}
568 0000
569 @end smallexample
570
571 @noindent
572 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
573 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
574 context where it stops.
575
576 @smallexample
577 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
578
579 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
580 at builtin.c:879
581 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
586 the next line of the current function.
587
588 @smallexample
589 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
590 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
591 : nil,
592 @end smallexample
593
594 @noindent
595 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
596 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
597 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
598 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
602 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
603 at input.c:530
604 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
605 @end smallexample
606
607 @noindent
608 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
609 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
610 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
611 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
612 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
613 stack frame for each active subroutine.
614
615 @smallexample
616 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
617 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
618 at input.c:530
619 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
620 at builtin.c:882
621 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
622 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
623 at macro.c:71
624 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
625 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
626 @end smallexample
627
628 @noindent
629 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
630 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
631 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
632
633 @smallexample
634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
635 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
637 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
638 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
640 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
641 : xstrdup(rq);
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
643 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
644 @end smallexample
645
646 @noindent
647 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
648 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
649 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
650 (@code{print}) to see their values.
651
652 @smallexample
653 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
654 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
655 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
656 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
657 @end smallexample
658
659 @noindent
660 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
661 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
662 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
663
664 @smallexample
665 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
666 533 xfree(rquote);
667 534
668 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
669 : xstrdup (lq);
670 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
671 : xstrdup (rq);
672 537
673 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
674 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
675 540 @}
676 541
677 542 void
678 @end smallexample
679
680 @noindent
681 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
682 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
686 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688 540 @}
689 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
690 $3 = 9
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
692 $4 = 7
693 @end smallexample
694
695 @noindent
696 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
697 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
698 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
699 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
700 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
701 assignments.
702
703 @smallexample
704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
705 $5 = 7
706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
707 $6 = 9
708 @end smallexample
709
710 @noindent
711 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
712 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
713 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
714 example that caused trouble initially:
715
716 @smallexample
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
718 Continuing.
719
720 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
721
722 baz
723 0000
724 @end smallexample
725
726 @noindent
727 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
728 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
729 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
730
731 @smallexample
732 @b{C-d}
733 Program exited normally.
734 @end smallexample
735
736 @noindent
737 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
738 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
739 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
743 @end smallexample
744
745 @node Invocation
746 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
747
748 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
749 The essentials are:
750 @itemize @bullet
751 @item
752 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
753 @item
754 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
755 @end itemize
756
757 @menu
758 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
759 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
760 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
761 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
762 @end menu
763
764 @node Invoking GDB
765 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
766
767 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
768 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
769
770 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
771 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
772
773 The command-line options described here are designed
774 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
775 options may effectively be unavailable.
776
777 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
778 specifying an executable program:
779
780 @smallexample
781 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
786 specified:
787
788 @smallexample
789 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
790 @end smallexample
791
792 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
793 to debug a running process:
794
795 @smallexample
796 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
797 @end smallexample
798
799 @noindent
800 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
801 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
802
803 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
804 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
805 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
806 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
807 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
808
809 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
810 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
811 option processing.
812 @smallexample
813 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
814 @end smallexample
815 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
816 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
817
818 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
819 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
820
821 @smallexample
822 @value{GDBP} -silent
823 @end smallexample
824
825 @noindent
826 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
827 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
828
829 @noindent
830 Type
831
832 @smallexample
833 @value{GDBP} -help
834 @end smallexample
835
836 @noindent
837 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
838 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
839
840 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
841 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
842 @samp{-x} option is used.
843
844
845 @menu
846 * File Options:: Choosing files
847 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
848 @end menu
849
850 @node File Options
851 @subsection Choosing files
852
853 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
854 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
855 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
856 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
857 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
858 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
859 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
860 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
861 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
862 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
863 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
864 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
865 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
866
867 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
868 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
869 argument and ignore it.
870
871 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
872 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
873 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
874 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
875 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
876
877 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
878 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
879 @c it.
880
881 @table @code
882 @item -symbols @var{file}
883 @itemx -s @var{file}
884 @cindex @code{--symbols}
885 @cindex @code{-s}
886 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
887
888 @item -exec @var{file}
889 @itemx -e @var{file}
890 @cindex @code{--exec}
891 @cindex @code{-e}
892 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
893 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
894
895 @item -se @var{file}
896 @cindex @code{--se}
897 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
898 file.
899
900 @item -core @var{file}
901 @itemx -c @var{file}
902 @cindex @code{--core}
903 @cindex @code{-c}
904 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
905
906 @item -c @var{number}
907 @item -pid @var{number}
908 @itemx -p @var{number}
909 @cindex @code{--pid}
910 @cindex @code{-p}
911 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
912 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
913 file named @var{number}.
914
915 @item -command @var{file}
916 @itemx -x @var{file}
917 @cindex @code{--command}
918 @cindex @code{-x}
919 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
920 Files,, Command files}.
921
922 @item -directory @var{directory}
923 @itemx -d @var{directory}
924 @cindex @code{--directory}
925 @cindex @code{-d}
926 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
927
928 @item -m
929 @itemx -mapped
930 @cindex @code{--mapped}
931 @cindex @code{-m}
932 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
933 supported on all systems.}@*
934 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
935 system call, you can use this option
936 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
937 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
938 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
939 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
940 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
941 the symbol table from the executable program.
942
943 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
944 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
945 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
946
947 @item -r
948 @itemx -readnow
949 @cindex @code{--readnow}
950 @cindex @code{-r}
951 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
952 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
953 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
954
955 @end table
956
957 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
958 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
959 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
960 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
961 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
962
963 @smallexample
964 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
965 @end smallexample
966
967 @node Mode Options
968 @subsection Choosing modes
969
970 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
971 batch mode or quiet mode.
972
973 @table @code
974 @item -nx
975 @itemx -n
976 @cindex @code{--nx}
977 @cindex @code{-n}
978 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
979 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
980 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
981 files}.
982
983 @item -quiet
984 @itemx -silent
985 @itemx -q
986 @cindex @code{--quiet}
987 @cindex @code{--silent}
988 @cindex @code{-q}
989 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
990 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
991
992 @item -batch
993 @cindex @code{--batch}
994 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
995 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
996 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
997 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
998 in the command files.
999
1000 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1001 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1002 make this more useful, the message
1003
1004 @smallexample
1005 Program exited normally.
1006 @end smallexample
1007
1008 @noindent
1009 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1010 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1011 mode.
1012
1013 @item -nowindows
1014 @itemx -nw
1015 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1016 @cindex @code{-nw}
1017 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1018 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1019 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1020
1021 @item -windows
1022 @itemx -w
1023 @cindex @code{--windows}
1024 @cindex @code{-w}
1025 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1026 used if possible.
1027
1028 @item -cd @var{directory}
1029 @cindex @code{--cd}
1030 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1031 instead of the current directory.
1032
1033 @item -fullname
1034 @itemx -f
1035 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1036 @cindex @code{-f}
1037 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1038 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1039 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1040 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1041 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1042 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1043 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1044 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1045 frame.
1046
1047 @item -epoch
1048 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1049 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1050 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1051 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1052 separate window.
1053
1054 @item -annotate @var{level}
1055 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1056 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1057 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1058 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1059 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1060 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1061 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1062 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1063 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1064
1065 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1066 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1067
1068 @item -async
1069 @cindex @code{--async}
1070 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1071 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1072 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1073 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1074 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1075 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1076 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1077 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1078 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1079 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1080 yet.)
1081 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1082 @c should be removed.
1083
1084 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1085 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1086 @samp{-noasync} option.
1087
1088 @item -noasync
1089 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1090 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1091
1092 @item --args
1093 @cindex @code{--args}
1094 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1095 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1096 This option stops option processing.
1097
1098 @item -baud @var{bps}
1099 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1100 @cindex @code{--baud}
1101 @cindex @code{-b}
1102 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1103 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1104
1105 @item -tty @var{device}
1106 @itemx -t @var{device}
1107 @cindex @code{--tty}
1108 @cindex @code{-t}
1109 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1110 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1111
1112 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1113 @item -tui
1114 @cindex @code{--tui}
1115 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1116 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1117 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1118 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1119 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1120 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1121
1122 @c @item -xdb
1123 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1124 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1125 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1126 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1127 @c systems.
1128
1129 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1130 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1131 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1132 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1133 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1134 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1135
1136 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1137 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1138 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included in @var{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1139 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3,
1140 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1141 interfaces are not supported.
1142
1143 @item -write
1144 @cindex @code{--write}
1145 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1146 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1147 (@pxref{Patching}).
1148
1149 @item -statistics
1150 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1151 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1152 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1153
1154 @item -version
1155 @cindex @code{--version}
1156 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1157 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1158
1159 @end table
1160
1161 @node Quitting GDB
1162 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1163 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1164 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1165
1166 @table @code
1167 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1168 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1169 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1170 @itemx q
1171 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1172 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1173 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1174 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1175 error code.
1176 @end table
1177
1178 @cindex interrupt
1179 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1180 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1181 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1182 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1183 until a time when it is safe.
1184
1185 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1186 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1187 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1188
1189 @node Shell Commands
1190 @section Shell commands
1191
1192 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1193 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1194 just use the @code{shell} command.
1195
1196 @table @code
1197 @kindex shell
1198 @cindex shell escape
1199 @item shell @var{command string}
1200 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1201 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1202 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1203 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1204 @end table
1205
1206 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1207 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1208 @value{GDBN}:
1209
1210 @table @code
1211 @kindex make
1212 @cindex calling make
1213 @item make @var{make-args}
1214 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1215 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1216 @end table
1217
1218 @node Logging output
1219 @section Logging output
1220 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1221
1222 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1223 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1224
1225 @table @code
1226 @kindex set logging
1227 @item set logging on
1228 Enable logging.
1229 @item set logging off
1230 Disable logging.
1231 @item set logging file @var{file}
1232 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1233 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1234 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1235 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1236 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1237 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1238 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1239 @kindex show logging
1240 @item show logging
1241 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1242 @end table
1243
1244 @node Commands
1245 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1246
1247 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1248 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1249 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1250 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1251 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1252
1253 @menu
1254 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1255 * Completion:: Command completion
1256 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1257 @end menu
1258
1259 @node Command Syntax
1260 @section Command syntax
1261
1262 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1263 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1264 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1265 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1266 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1267 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1268
1269 @cindex abbreviation
1270 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1271 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1272 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1273 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1274 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1275 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1276 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1277
1278 @cindex repeating commands
1279 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1280 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1281 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1282 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1283 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1284 repeat.
1285
1286 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1287 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1288 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1289
1290 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1291 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1292 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1293 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1294 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1295
1296 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1297 @cindex comment
1298 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1299 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1300 Files,,Command files}).
1301
1302 @cindex repeating command sequences
1303 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1304 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1305 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1306 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1307 for editing.
1308
1309 @node Completion
1310 @section Command completion
1311
1312 @cindex completion
1313 @cindex word completion
1314 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1315 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1316 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1317 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1318
1319 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1320 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1321 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1322 enter it). For example, if you type
1323
1324 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1325 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1326 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1327 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1328 @smallexample
1329 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1330 @end smallexample
1331
1332 @noindent
1333 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1334 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1335
1336 @smallexample
1337 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1338 @end smallexample
1339
1340 @noindent
1341 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1342 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1343 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1344 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1345 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1346 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1347
1348 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1349 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1350 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1351 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1352 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1353 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1354 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1355 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1356 example:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1360 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1361 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1362 make_abs_section make_function_type
1363 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1364 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1365 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1366 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1367 @end smallexample
1368
1369 @noindent
1370 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1371 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1372 command.
1373
1374 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1375 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1376 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1377 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1378 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1379
1380 @cindex quotes in commands
1381 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1382 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1383 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1384 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1385 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1386 @value{GDBN} commands.
1387
1388 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1389 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1390 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1391 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1392 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1393 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1394 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1395 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1396 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1397 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1398 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1399
1400 @smallexample
1401 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1402 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1403 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1404 @end smallexample
1405
1406 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1407 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1408 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1409 place:
1410
1411 @smallexample
1412 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1413 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1414 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1415 @end smallexample
1416
1417 @noindent
1418 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1419 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1420 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1421
1422 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1423 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1424 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1425 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1426
1427
1428 @node Help
1429 @section Getting help
1430 @cindex online documentation
1431 @kindex help
1432
1433 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1434 using the command @code{help}.
1435
1436 @table @code
1437 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1438 @item help
1439 @itemx h
1440 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1441 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1442
1443 @smallexample
1444 (@value{GDBP}) help
1445 List of classes of commands:
1446
1447 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1448 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1449 data -- Examining data
1450 files -- Specifying and examining files
1451 internals -- Maintenance commands
1452 obscure -- Obscure features
1453 running -- Running the program
1454 stack -- Examining the stack
1455 status -- Status inquiries
1456 support -- Support facilities
1457 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1458 stopping the program
1459 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1460
1461 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1462 commands in that class.
1463 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1464 documentation.
1465 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1466 (@value{GDBP})
1467 @end smallexample
1468 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1469
1470 @item help @var{class}
1471 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1472 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1473 help display for the class @code{status}:
1474
1475 @smallexample
1476 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1477 Status inquiries.
1478
1479 List of commands:
1480
1481 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1482 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1483 info -- Generic command for showing things
1484 about the program being debugged
1485 show -- Generic command for showing things
1486 about the debugger
1487
1488 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1489 documentation.
1490 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1491 (@value{GDBP})
1492 @end smallexample
1493
1494 @item help @var{command}
1495 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1496 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1497
1498 @kindex apropos
1499 @item apropos @var{args}
1500 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1501 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1502 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1503
1504 @smallexample
1505 apropos reload
1506 @end smallexample
1507
1508 @noindent
1509 results in:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 @c @group
1513 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1514 multiple times in one run
1515 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1516 multiple times in one run
1517 @c @end group
1518 @end smallexample
1519
1520 @kindex complete
1521 @item complete @var{args}
1522 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1523 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1524 command you want completed. For example:
1525
1526 @smallexample
1527 complete i
1528 @end smallexample
1529
1530 @noindent results in:
1531
1532 @smallexample
1533 @group
1534 if
1535 ignore
1536 info
1537 inspect
1538 @end group
1539 @end smallexample
1540
1541 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1542 @end table
1543
1544 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1545 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1546 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1547 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1548 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1549 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1550
1551 @c @group
1552 @table @code
1553 @kindex info
1554 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1555 @item info
1556 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1557 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1558 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1559 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1560 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1561 @w{@code{help info}}.
1562
1563 @kindex set
1564 @item set
1565 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1566 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1567 @code{set prompt $}.
1568
1569 @kindex show
1570 @item show
1571 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1572 @value{GDBN} itself.
1573 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1574 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1575 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1576 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1577
1578 @kindex info set
1579 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1580 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1581 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1582 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1583 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1584 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1585 @end table
1586 @c @end group
1587
1588 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1589 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1590
1591 @table @code
1592 @kindex show version
1593 @cindex version number
1594 @item show version
1595 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1596 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1597 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1598 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1599 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1600 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1601 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1602 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1603 @value{GDBN}.
1604
1605 @kindex show copying
1606 @item show copying
1607 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1608
1609 @kindex show warranty
1610 @item show warranty
1611 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1612 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1613
1614 @end table
1615
1616 @node Running
1617 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1618
1619 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1620 debugging information when you compile it.
1621
1622 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1623 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1624 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1625 kill a child process.
1626
1627 @menu
1628 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1629 * Starting:: Starting your program
1630 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1631 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1632
1633 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1634 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1635 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1636 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1637
1638 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1639 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1640 @end menu
1641
1642 @node Compilation
1643 @section Compiling for debugging
1644
1645 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1646 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1647 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1648 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1649 and addresses in the executable code.
1650
1651 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1652 the compiler.
1653
1654 Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1655 the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1656 because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1657 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1658 options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1659 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1660 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1661 to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1662 @option{-g} alone.
1663
1664 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1665 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1666 executables containing debugging information.
1667
1668 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1669 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1670 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1671 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1672 in pushing your luck.
1673
1674 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1675 @cindex debugging optimized code
1676 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1677 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1678 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1679 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1680 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1681 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1682
1683 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1684 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1685 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1686 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1687
1688 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1689 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1690 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1691
1692 @need 2000
1693 @node Starting
1694 @section Starting your program
1695 @cindex starting
1696 @cindex running
1697
1698 @table @code
1699 @kindex run
1700 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1701 @item run
1702 @itemx r
1703 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1704 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1705 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1706 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1707 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1708
1709 @end table
1710
1711 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1712 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1713 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1714 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1715
1716 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1717 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1718 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1719 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1720 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1721 divided into four categories:
1722
1723 @table @asis
1724 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1725 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1726 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1727 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1728 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1729 the arguments.
1730 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1731 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1732 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1733
1734 @item The @emph{environment.}
1735 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1736 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1737 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1738 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1739
1740 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1741 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1742 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1743 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1744
1745 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1746 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1747 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1748 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1749 set a different device for your program.
1750 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1751
1752 @cindex pipes
1753 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1754 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1755 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1756 wrong program.
1757 @end table
1758
1759 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1760 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1761 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1762 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1763 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1764
1765 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1766 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1767 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1768 your current breakpoints.
1769
1770 @node Arguments
1771 @section Your program's arguments
1772
1773 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1774 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1775 @code{run} command.
1776 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1777 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1778 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1779 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1780 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1781
1782 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1783 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1784 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1785 the program, not by the shell.
1786
1787 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1788 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1789
1790 @table @code
1791 @kindex set args
1792 @item set args
1793 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1794 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1795 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1796 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1797 it again without arguments.
1798
1799 @kindex show args
1800 @item show args
1801 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1802 @end table
1803
1804 @node Environment
1805 @section Your program's environment
1806
1807 @cindex environment (of your program)
1808 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1809 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1810 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1811 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1812 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1813 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1814 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1815
1816 @table @code
1817 @kindex path
1818 @item path @var{directory}
1819 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1820 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1821 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1822 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1823 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1824 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1825 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1826
1827 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1828 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1829 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1830 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1831 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1832 @var{directory} to the search path.
1833 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1834 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1835
1836 @kindex show paths
1837 @item show paths
1838 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1839 environment variable).
1840
1841 @kindex show environment
1842 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1843 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1844 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1845 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1846 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1847
1848 @kindex set environment
1849 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1850 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1851 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1852 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1853 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1854 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1855 null value.
1856 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1857 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1858
1859 For example, this command:
1860
1861 @smallexample
1862 set env USER = foo
1863 @end smallexample
1864
1865 @noindent
1866 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1867 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1868 are not actually required.)
1869
1870 @kindex unset environment
1871 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1872 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1873 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1874 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1875 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1879 the shell indicated
1880 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1881 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1882 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1883 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1884 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1885 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1886 @file{.profile}.
1887
1888 @node Working Directory
1889 @section Your program's working directory
1890
1891 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1892 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1893 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1894 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1895 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1896 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1897
1898 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1899 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1900 specify files}.
1901
1902 @table @code
1903 @kindex cd
1904 @item cd @var{directory}
1905 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1906
1907 @kindex pwd
1908 @item pwd
1909 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1910 @end table
1911
1912 @node Input/Output
1913 @section Your program's input and output
1914
1915 @cindex redirection
1916 @cindex i/o
1917 @cindex terminal
1918 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1919 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1920 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1921 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1922 running your program.
1923
1924 @table @code
1925 @kindex info terminal
1926 @item info terminal
1927 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1928 program is using.
1929 @end table
1930
1931 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1932 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1933
1934 @smallexample
1935 run > outfile
1936 @end smallexample
1937
1938 @noindent
1939 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1940
1941 @kindex tty
1942 @cindex controlling terminal
1943 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1944 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1945 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1946 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1947 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1948
1949 @smallexample
1950 tty /dev/ttyb
1951 @end smallexample
1952
1953 @noindent
1954 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1955 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1956 that as their controlling terminal.
1957
1958 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1959 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1960 terminal.
1961
1962 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1963 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1964 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1965
1966 @node Attach
1967 @section Debugging an already-running process
1968 @kindex attach
1969 @cindex attach
1970
1971 @table @code
1972 @item attach @var{process-id}
1973 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1974 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1975 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1976 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1977 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1978
1979 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1980 executing the command.
1981 @end table
1982
1983 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1984 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1985 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1986 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1987
1988 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1989 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1990 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1991 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1992 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1993 Specify Files}.
1994
1995 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1996 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1997 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1998 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1999 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2000 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2001 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2002
2003 @table @code
2004 @kindex detach
2005 @item detach
2006 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2007 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2008 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2009 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2010 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2011 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2012 executing the command.
2013 @end table
2014
2015 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2016 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2017 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2018 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2019 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2020 messages}).
2021
2022 @node Kill Process
2023 @section Killing the child process
2024
2025 @table @code
2026 @kindex kill
2027 @item kill
2028 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2029 @end table
2030
2031 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2032 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2033 is running.
2034
2035 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2036 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2037 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2038 outside the debugger.
2039
2040 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2041 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2042 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2043 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2044 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2045 breakpoint settings).
2046
2047 @node Threads
2048 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2049
2050 @cindex threads of execution
2051 @cindex multiple threads
2052 @cindex switching threads
2053 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2054 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2055 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2056 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2057 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2058 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2059 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2060
2061 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2062 programs:
2063
2064 @itemize @bullet
2065 @item automatic notification of new threads
2066 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2067 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2068 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2069 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2070 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2071 @end itemize
2072
2073 @quotation
2074 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2075 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2076 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2077 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2078 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2079 like this:
2080
2081 @smallexample
2082 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2083 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2084 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2085 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2086 @end smallexample
2087 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2088 @c doesn't support threads"?
2089 @end quotation
2090
2091 @cindex focus of debugging
2092 @cindex current thread
2093 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2094 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2095 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2096 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2097 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2098
2099 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2100 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2101 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2102 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2103 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2104 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2105 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2106 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2107 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2108 LynxOS, you might see
2109
2110 @smallexample
2111 [New process 35 thread 27]
2112 @end smallexample
2113
2114 @noindent
2115 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2116 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2117 further qualifier.
2118
2119 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2120 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2121 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2122 @c program?
2123 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2124 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2125 @c threads ab initio?
2126
2127 @cindex thread number
2128 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2129 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2130 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2131
2132 @table @code
2133 @kindex info threads
2134 @item info threads
2135 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2136 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2137
2138 @enumerate
2139 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2140
2141 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2142
2143 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2144 @end enumerate
2145
2146 @noindent
2147 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2148 indicates the current thread.
2149
2150 For example,
2151 @end table
2152 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2153
2154 @smallexample
2155 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2156 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2157 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2158 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2159 at threadtest.c:68
2160 @end smallexample
2161
2162 On HP-UX systems:
2163
2164 @cindex thread number
2165 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2166 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2167 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2168 thread in your program.
2169
2170 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2171 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2172 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2173 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2174 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2175 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2176 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2177 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2178 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2179 HP-UX, you see
2180
2181 @smallexample
2182 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2183 @end smallexample
2184
2185 @noindent
2186 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2187
2188 @table @code
2189 @kindex info threads
2190 @item info threads
2191 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2192 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2193
2194 @enumerate
2195 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2196
2197 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2198
2199 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2200 @end enumerate
2201
2202 @noindent
2203 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2204 indicates the current thread.
2205
2206 For example,
2207 @end table
2208 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2209
2210 @smallexample
2211 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2212 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2213 at quicksort.c:137
2214 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2215 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2216 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2217 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 @table @code
2221 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2222 @item thread @var{threadno}
2223 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2224 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2225 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2226 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2227 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2228
2229 @smallexample
2230 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2231 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2232 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2233 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2234 @end smallexample
2235
2236 @noindent
2237 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2238 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2239 threads.
2240
2241 @kindex thread apply
2242 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2243 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2244 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2245 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2246 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2247 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2248 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2249 @end table
2250
2251 @cindex automatic thread selection
2252 @cindex switching threads automatically
2253 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2254 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2255 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2256 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2257 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2258 thread.
2259
2260 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2261 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2262 programs with multiple threads.
2263
2264 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2265 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2266
2267 @node Processes
2268 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2269
2270 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2271 @cindex multiple processes
2272 @cindex processes, multiple
2273 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2274 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2275 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2276 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2277 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2278 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2279 will cause it to terminate.
2280
2281 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2282 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2283 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2284 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2285 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2286 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2287 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2288 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2289 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2290 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2291
2292 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2293 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2294 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2295 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2296
2297 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2298 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2299
2300 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2301 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2302
2303 @table @code
2304 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2305 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2306 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2307 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2308 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2309
2310 @table @code
2311 @item parent
2312 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2313 unimpeded. This is the default.
2314
2315 @item child
2316 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2317 unimpeded.
2318
2319 @end table
2320
2321 @item show follow-fork-mode
2322 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2323 @end table
2324
2325 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2326 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2327 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2328 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2329 the child process's @code{main}.
2330
2331 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2332 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2333
2334 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2335 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2336 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2337 argument.
2338
2339 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2340 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2341 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2342
2343 @node Stopping
2344 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2345
2346 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2347 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2348 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2349
2350 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2351 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2352 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2353 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2354 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2355 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2356 explicitly request this information at any time.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex info program
2360 @item info program
2361 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2362 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2363 @end table
2364
2365 @menu
2366 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2367 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2368 * Signals:: Signals
2369 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2370 @end menu
2371
2372 @node Breakpoints
2373 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2374
2375 @cindex breakpoints
2376 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2377 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2378 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2379 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2380 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2381 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2382 program.
2383
2384 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2385 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2386 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2387 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2388 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2389 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2390
2391 @cindex watchpoints
2392 @cindex memory tracing
2393 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2394 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2395 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2396 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2397 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2398 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2399 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2400 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2401
2402 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2403 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2404 Automatic display}.
2405
2406 @cindex catchpoints
2407 @cindex breakpoint on events
2408 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2409 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2410 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2411 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2412 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2413 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2414 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2415
2416 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2417 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2418 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2419 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2420 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2421 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2422 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2423 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2424 enable it again.
2425
2426 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2427 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2428 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2429 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2430 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2431 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2432 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2433
2434 @menu
2435 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2436 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2437 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2438 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2439 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2440 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2441 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2442 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2443 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2444 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2445 @end menu
2446
2447 @node Set Breaks
2448 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2449
2450 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2451 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2452 @c
2453 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2454
2455 @kindex break
2456 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2457 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2458 @cindex latest breakpoint
2459 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2460 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2461 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2462 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2463 convenience variables.
2464
2465 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2466
2467 @table @code
2468 @item break @var{function}
2469 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2470 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2471 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2472 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2473
2474 @item break +@var{offset}
2475 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2476 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2477 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2478 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2479
2480 @item break @var{linenum}
2481 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2482 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2483 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2484 code on that line.
2485
2486 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2487 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2488
2489 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2490 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2491 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2492 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2493 functions.
2494
2495 @item break *@var{address}
2496 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2497 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2498 information or source files.
2499
2500 @item break
2501 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2502 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2503 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2504 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2505 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2506 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2507 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2508 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2509 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2510 inside loops.
2511
2512 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2513 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2514 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2515 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2516 existed when your program stopped.
2517
2518 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2519 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2520 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2521 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2522 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2523 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2524 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2525
2526 @kindex tbreak
2527 @item tbreak @var{args}
2528 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2529 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2530 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2531 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2532
2533 @kindex hbreak
2534 @item hbreak @var{args}
2535 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2536 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2537 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2538 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2539 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2540 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2541 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2542 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2543 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2544 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2545 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2546 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2547 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2548 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2549 @xref{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2550
2551
2552 @kindex thbreak
2553 @item thbreak @var{args}
2554 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2555 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2556 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2557 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2558 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2559 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2560 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2561 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2562
2563 @kindex rbreak
2564 @cindex regular expression
2565 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2566 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2567 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2568 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2569 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2570 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2571 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2572
2573 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2574 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2575 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2576 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2577 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2578 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2579
2580 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2581 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2582 classes.
2583
2584 @kindex info breakpoints
2585 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2586 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2587 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2588 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2589 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2590 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2591
2592 @table @emph
2593 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2594 @item Type
2595 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2596 @item Disposition
2597 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2598 @item Enabled or Disabled
2599 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2600 that are not enabled.
2601 @item Address
2602 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2603 @item What
2604 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2605 line number.
2606 @end table
2607
2608 @noindent
2609 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2610 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2611 are listed after that.
2612
2613 @noindent
2614 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2615 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2616 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2617 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2618 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2619
2620 @noindent
2621 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2622 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2623 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2624 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2625 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2626 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2627 @end table
2628
2629 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2630 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2631 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2632 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2633
2634 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2635 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2636 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2637 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2638 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2639 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2640 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2641 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2642
2643
2644 @node Set Watchpoints
2645 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2646
2647 @cindex setting watchpoints
2648 @cindex software watchpoints
2649 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2650 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2651 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2652 this may happen.
2653
2654 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2655 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2656 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2657 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2658 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2659 culprit.)
2660
2661 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2662 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2663 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2664 program.
2665
2666 @table @code
2667 @kindex watch
2668 @item watch @var{expr}
2669 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2670 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2671
2672 @kindex rwatch
2673 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2674 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2675
2676 @kindex awatch
2677 @item awatch @var{expr}
2678 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2679 by the program.
2680
2681 @kindex info watchpoints
2682 @item info watchpoints
2683 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2684 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2685 @end table
2686
2687 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2688 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2689 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2690 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2691 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2692 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2693
2694 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2695
2696 @smallexample
2697 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2698 @end smallexample
2699
2700 @noindent
2701 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2702
2703 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2704 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2705 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2706 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2707 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2708 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2709 will print a message like this:
2710
2711 @smallexample
2712 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2713 @end smallexample
2714
2715 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2716 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2717 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2718 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2719 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2720 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2721 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2722 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2723
2724 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2725 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2726 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2727 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2728 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2729 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2730
2731 @smallexample
2732 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2733 @end smallexample
2734
2735 @noindent
2736 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2737
2738 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2739 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2740 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2741 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2742 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2743 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2744 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2745 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2746 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2747 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2748
2749 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2750 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2751 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2752
2753 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2754 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2755 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2756 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2757 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2758 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2759 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2760 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2761 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2762
2763 @quotation
2764 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2765 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2766 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2767 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2768 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2769 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2770 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2771 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2772 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2773 the expression.
2774
2775 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2776 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2777 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2778 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2779 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2780 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2781 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2782 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2783 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2784 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2785 @end quotation
2786
2787 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
2788
2789 @node Set Catchpoints
2790 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2791 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2792 @cindex exception handlers
2793 @cindex event handling
2794
2795 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2796 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2797 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2798
2799 @table @code
2800 @kindex catch
2801 @item catch @var{event}
2802 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2803 @table @code
2804 @item throw
2805 @kindex catch throw
2806 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2807
2808 @item catch
2809 @kindex catch catch
2810 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2811
2812 @item exec
2813 @kindex catch exec
2814 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2815
2816 @item fork
2817 @kindex catch fork
2818 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2819
2820 @item vfork
2821 @kindex catch vfork
2822 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2823
2824 @item load
2825 @itemx load @var{libname}
2826 @kindex catch load
2827 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2828 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2829
2830 @item unload
2831 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2832 @kindex catch unload
2833 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2834 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 @item tcatch @var{event}
2838 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2839 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2840
2841 @end table
2842
2843 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2844
2845 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2846 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2847
2848 @itemize @bullet
2849 @item
2850 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2851 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2852 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2853 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2854 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2855 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2856 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2857 disabled within interactive calls.
2858
2859 @item
2860 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2861
2862 @item
2863 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2864 @end itemize
2865
2866 @cindex raise exceptions
2867 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2868 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2869 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2870 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2871 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2872 out where the exception was raised.
2873
2874 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2875 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2876 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2877 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2878
2879 @smallexample
2880 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2881 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2882 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2883 @end smallexample
2884
2885 @noindent
2886 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2887 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2888 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2889
2890 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2891 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2892 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2893 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2894 raised.
2895
2896
2897 @node Delete Breaks
2898 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2899
2900 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2901 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2902 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2903 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2904 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2905 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2906
2907 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2908 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2909 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2910 their breakpoint numbers.
2911
2912 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2913 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2914 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2915
2916 @table @code
2917 @kindex clear
2918 @item clear
2919 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2920 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2921 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2922 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2923
2924 @item clear @var{function}
2925 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2926 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2927
2928 @item clear @var{linenum}
2929 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2930 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2931
2932 @cindex delete breakpoints
2933 @kindex delete
2934 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2935 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2936 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2937 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2938 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2939 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2940 @end table
2941
2942 @node Disabling
2943 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2944
2945 @kindex disable breakpoints
2946 @kindex enable breakpoints
2947 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2948 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2949 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2950 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2951
2952 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2953 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2954 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2955 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2956 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2957
2958 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2959 states of enablement:
2960
2961 @itemize @bullet
2962 @item
2963 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2964 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2965 @item
2966 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2967 @item
2968 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2969 disabled.
2970 @item
2971 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2972 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2973 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2974 @end itemize
2975
2976 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2977 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2978
2979 @table @code
2980 @kindex disable breakpoints
2981 @kindex disable
2982 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2983 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2984 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2985 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2986 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2987 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2988 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2989
2990 @kindex enable breakpoints
2991 @kindex enable
2992 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2993 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2994 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2995
2996 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2997 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2998 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2999
3000 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3001 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3002 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3003 @end table
3004
3005 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3006 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3007 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3008 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3009 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3010 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3011 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3012 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3013 stepping}.)
3014
3015 @node Conditions
3016 @subsection Break conditions
3017 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3018 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3019
3020 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3021 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3022 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3023 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3024 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3025 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3026 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3027 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3028
3029 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3030 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3031 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3032 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3033 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3034
3035 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3036 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3037 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3038 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3039 one.
3040
3041 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3042 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3043 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3044 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3045 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3046 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3047 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3048 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3049 conditions for the
3050 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3051 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3052
3053 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3054 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3055 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3056 with the @code{condition} command.
3057
3058 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3059 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3060 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3061 catchpoint.
3062
3063 @table @code
3064 @kindex condition
3065 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3066 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3067 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3068 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3069 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3070 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3071 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3072 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3073 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3074 prints an error message:
3075
3076 @smallexample
3077 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3078 @end smallexample
3079
3080 @noindent
3081 @value{GDBN} does
3082 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3083 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3084 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3085
3086 @item condition @var{bnum}
3087 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3088 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3089 @end table
3090
3091 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3092 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3093 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3094 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3095 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3096 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3097 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3098 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3099 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3100 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3101 your program reaches it.
3102
3103 @table @code
3104 @kindex ignore
3105 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3106 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3107 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3108 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3109 takes no action.
3110
3111 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3112 a count of zero.
3113
3114 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3115 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3116 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3117 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3118
3119 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3120 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3121 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3122
3123 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3124 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3125 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3126 variables}.
3127 @end table
3128
3129 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3130
3131
3132 @node Break Commands
3133 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3134
3135 @cindex breakpoint commands
3136 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3137 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3138 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3139 enable other breakpoints.
3140
3141 @table @code
3142 @kindex commands
3143 @kindex end
3144 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3145 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3146 @itemx end
3147 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3148 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3149 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3150
3151 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3152 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3153
3154 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3155 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3156 recently encountered).
3157 @end table
3158
3159 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3160 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3161
3162 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3163 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3164 that resumes execution.
3165
3166 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3167 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3168 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3169 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3170 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3171
3172 @kindex silent
3173 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3174 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3175 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3176 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3177 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3178 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3179
3180 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3181 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3182 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3183
3184 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3185 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3186
3187 @smallexample
3188 break foo if x>0
3189 commands
3190 silent
3191 printf "x is %d\n",x
3192 cont
3193 end
3194 @end smallexample
3195
3196 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3197 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3198 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3199 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3200 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3201 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3202 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3203
3204 @smallexample
3205 break 403
3206 commands
3207 silent
3208 set x = y + 4
3209 cont
3210 end
3211 @end smallexample
3212
3213 @node Breakpoint Menus
3214 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3215 @cindex overloading
3216 @cindex symbol overloading
3217
3218 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3219 single function name
3220 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3221 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3222 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3223 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3224 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3225 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3226 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3227 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3228 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3229 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3230 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3231 breakpoints.
3232
3233 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3234 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3235 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3236
3237 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3238 @smallexample
3239 @group
3240 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3241 [0] cancel
3242 [1] all
3243 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3244 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3245 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3246 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3247 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3248 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3249 > 2 4 6
3250 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3251 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3252 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3253 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3254 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3255 breakpoints.
3256 (@value{GDBP})
3257 @end group
3258 @end smallexample
3259
3260 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3261 @node Error in Breakpoints
3262 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3263 @c
3264 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3265 @c
3266 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3267 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3268 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3269 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3270
3271 @smallexample
3272 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3273 The same program may be running in another process.
3274 @end smallexample
3275
3276 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3277
3278 @enumerate
3279 @item
3280 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3281
3282 @item
3283 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3284 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3285 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3286 Then start your program again.
3287
3288 @item
3289 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3290 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3291 to nonsharable executables.
3292 @end enumerate
3293 @c @end ifclear
3294
3295 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3296 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3297
3298 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3299 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3300 @smallexample
3301 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3302 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3303 @end smallexample
3304
3305 @noindent
3306 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3307 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3308 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3309
3310 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3311 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3312
3313 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3314 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3315 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3316
3317 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3318 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3319 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3320 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3321
3322 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3323 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3324 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3325 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3326 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3327 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3328 first in the bundle.
3329
3330 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3331 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3332 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3333 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3334 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3335 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3336 is hit.
3337
3338 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3339 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3340
3341 @smallexample
3342 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3343 @end smallexample
3344
3345 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3346 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3347 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3348 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3349 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3350 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3351 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3352 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3353
3354 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3355 adjusted breakpoints:
3356
3357 @smallexample
3358 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3359 to 0x00010410.
3360 @end smallexample
3361
3362 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3363 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3364 frequently than expected.
3365
3366 @node Continuing and Stepping
3367 @section Continuing and stepping
3368
3369 @cindex stepping
3370 @cindex continuing
3371 @cindex resuming execution
3372 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3373 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3374 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3375 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3376 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3377 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3378 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3379 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3380
3381 @table @code
3382 @kindex continue
3383 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3384 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3385 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3386 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3387 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3388 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3389 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3390 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3391 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3392 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3393
3394 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3395 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3396 @code{continue} is ignored.
3397
3398 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3399 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3400 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3401 @code{continue}.
3402 @end table
3403
3404 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3405 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3406 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3407 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3408
3409 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3410 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3411 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3412 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3413 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3414 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3415
3416 @table @code
3417 @kindex step
3418 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3419 @item step
3420 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3421 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3422 abbreviated @code{s}.
3423
3424 @quotation
3425 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3426 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3427 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3428 @c distinction here.
3429 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3430 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3431 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3432 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3433 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3434 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3435 below.
3436 @end quotation
3437
3438 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3439 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3440 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3441 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3442 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3443 called within the line.
3444
3445 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3446 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3447 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3448 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3449 was any debugging information about the routine.
3450
3451 @item step @var{count}
3452 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3453 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3454 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3455
3456 @kindex next
3457 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3458 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3459 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3460 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3461 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3462 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3463 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3464 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3465
3466 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3467
3468
3469 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3470 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3471 @c
3472 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3473 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3474 @c function are executed without stopping.
3475
3476 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3477 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3478 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3479
3480 @kindex set step-mode
3481 @item set step-mode
3482 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3483 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3484 @itemx set step-mode on
3485 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3486 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3487 information rather than stepping over it.
3488
3489 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3490 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3491 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3492
3493 @item set step-mode off
3494 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3495 debug information. This is the default.
3496
3497 @kindex finish
3498 @item finish
3499 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3500 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3501
3502 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3503 ,Returning from a function}).
3504
3505 @kindex until
3506 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3507 @item until
3508 @itemx u
3509 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3510 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3511 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3512 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3513 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3514 than the address of the jump.
3515
3516 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3517 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3518 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3519 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3520 through the next iteration.
3521
3522 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3523 stack frame.
3524
3525 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3526 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3527 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3528 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3529 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3530
3531 @smallexample
3532 (@value{GDBP}) f
3533 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3534 206 expand_input();
3535 (@value{GDBP}) until
3536 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3537 @end smallexample
3538
3539 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3540 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3541 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3542 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3543 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3544 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3545 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3546
3547 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3548 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3549 argument.
3550
3551 @item until @var{location}
3552 @itemx u @var{location}
3553 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3554 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3555 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3556 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3557 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3558 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3559 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3560 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3561 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3562 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3563 invocations have returned.
3564
3565 @smallexample
3566 94 int factorial (int value)
3567 95 @{
3568 96 if (value > 1) @{
3569 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
3570 98 @}
3571 99 return (value);
3572 100 @}
3573 @end smallexample
3574
3575
3576 @kindex advance @var{location}
3577 @itemx advance @var{location}
3578 Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3579 required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3580 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3581 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3582 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3583 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3584
3585
3586 @kindex stepi
3587 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3588 @item stepi
3589 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3590 @itemx si
3591 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3592
3593 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3594 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3595 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3596 Display,, Automatic display}.
3597
3598 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3599
3600 @need 750
3601 @kindex nexti
3602 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3603 @item nexti
3604 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3605 @itemx ni
3606 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3607 proceed until the function returns.
3608
3609 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3610 @end table
3611
3612 @node Signals
3613 @section Signals
3614 @cindex signals
3615
3616 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3617 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3618 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3619 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3620 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3621 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3622 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3623 requested an alarm).
3624
3625 @cindex fatal signals
3626 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3627 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3628 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3629 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3630 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3631 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3632
3633 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3634 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3635 signal.
3636
3637 @cindex handling signals
3638 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3639 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3640 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3641 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3642 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3643
3644 @table @code
3645 @kindex info signals
3646 @item info signals
3647 @itemx info handle
3648 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3649 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3650 the defined types of signals.
3651
3652 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3653
3654 @kindex handle
3655 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3656 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3657 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3658 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3659 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3660 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3661 @end table
3662
3663 @c @group
3664 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3665 Their full names are:
3666
3667 @table @code
3668 @item nostop
3669 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3670 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3671
3672 @item stop
3673 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3674 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3675
3676 @item print
3677 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3678
3679 @item noprint
3680 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3681 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3682
3683 @item pass
3684 @itemx noignore
3685 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3686 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3687 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3688
3689 @item nopass
3690 @itemx ignore
3691 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3692 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3693 @end table
3694 @c @end group
3695
3696 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3697 program until you
3698 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3699 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3700 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3701 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3702 program sees that signal when you continue.
3703
3704 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3705 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3706 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3707 erroneous signals.
3708
3709 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3710 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3711 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3712 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3713 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3714 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3715 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3716 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3717 program a signal}.
3718
3719 @node Thread Stops
3720 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3721
3722 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3723 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3724 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3725
3726 @table @code
3727 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3728 @cindex thread breakpoints
3729 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3730 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3731 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3732 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3733 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3734
3735 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3736 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3737 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3738 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3739 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3740
3741 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3742 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3743 program.
3744
3745 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3746 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3747 breakpoint condition, like this:
3748
3749 @smallexample
3750 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3751 @end smallexample
3752
3753 @end table
3754
3755 @cindex stopped threads
3756 @cindex threads, stopped
3757 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3758 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3759 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3760 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3761 underfoot.
3762
3763 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
3764 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
3765 @cindex premature return from system calls
3766 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
3767 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
3768 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
3769 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
3770 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
3771 stop execution.
3772
3773 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
3774 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
3775 style anyways.
3776
3777 For example, do not write code like this:
3778
3779 @smallexample
3780 sleep (10);
3781 @end smallexample
3782
3783 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
3784 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
3785
3786 Instead, write this:
3787
3788 @smallexample
3789 int unslept = 10;
3790 while (unslept > 0)
3791 unslept = sleep (unslept);
3792 @end smallexample
3793
3794 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
3795 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
3796 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
3797 @value{GDBN}.
3798
3799 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
3800 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
3801 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
3802 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
3803
3804 @cindex continuing threads
3805 @cindex threads, continuing
3806 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3807 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3808 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3809
3810 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3811 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3812 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3813 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3814 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3815 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3816 stops.
3817
3818 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3819 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3820 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3821 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3822
3823 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3824 thread to run.
3825
3826 @table @code
3827 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3828 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3829 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3830 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3831 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3832 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3833 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3834 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3835 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3836 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3837 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3838 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3839
3840 @item show scheduler-locking
3841 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3842 @end table
3843
3844
3845 @node Stack
3846 @chapter Examining the Stack
3847
3848 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3849 stopped and how it got there.
3850
3851 @cindex call stack
3852 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3853 is generated.
3854 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3855 the arguments of the call,
3856 and the local variables of the function being called.
3857 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3858 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3859 stack}.
3860
3861 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3862 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3863
3864 @cindex selected frame
3865 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3866 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3867 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3868 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3869 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3870 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3871
3872 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3873 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3874 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3875
3876 @menu
3877 * Frames:: Stack frames
3878 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3879 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3880 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3881
3882 @end menu
3883
3884 @node Frames
3885 @section Stack frames
3886
3887 @cindex frame, definition
3888 @cindex stack frame
3889 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3890 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3891 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3892 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3893 which the function is executing.
3894
3895 @cindex initial frame
3896 @cindex outermost frame
3897 @cindex innermost frame
3898 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3899 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3900 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3901 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3902 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3903 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3904 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3905 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3906
3907 @cindex frame pointer
3908 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3909 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3910 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3911 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3912 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3913 going on in that frame.
3914
3915 @cindex frame number
3916 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3917 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3918 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3919 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3920 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3921
3922 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3923 @c underflow problems.
3924 @cindex frameless execution
3925 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3926 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3927 @smallexample
3928 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3929 @end smallexample
3930 generates functions without a frame.)
3931 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3932 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3933 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3934 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3935 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3936 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3937 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3938
3939 @table @code
3940 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3941 @cindex current stack frame
3942 @item frame @var{args}
3943 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3944 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3945 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3946 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3947
3948 @kindex select-frame
3949 @cindex selecting frame silently
3950 @item select-frame
3951 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3952 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3953 @code{frame}.
3954 @end table
3955
3956 @node Backtrace
3957 @section Backtraces
3958
3959 @cindex backtraces
3960 @cindex tracebacks
3961 @cindex stack traces
3962 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3963 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3964 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3965 stack.
3966
3967 @table @code
3968 @kindex backtrace
3969 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3970 @item backtrace
3971 @itemx bt
3972 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3973 frames in the stack.
3974
3975 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3976 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3977
3978 @item backtrace @var{n}
3979 @itemx bt @var{n}
3980 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3981
3982 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3983 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3984 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3985 @end table
3986
3987 @kindex where
3988 @kindex info stack
3989 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3990 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3991 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3992
3993 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3994 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3995 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3996 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3997 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3998 line number.
3999
4000 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4001 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4002
4003 @smallexample
4004 @group
4005 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4006 at builtin.c:993
4007 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4008 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4009 at macro.c:71
4010 (More stack frames follow...)
4011 @end group
4012 @end smallexample
4013
4014 @noindent
4015 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4016 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4017 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4018
4019 @kindex set backtrace past-main
4020 @kindex show backtrace past-main
4021 @kindex set backtrace limit
4022 @kindex show backtrace limit
4023
4024 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4025 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4026 @code{main}. When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4027 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4028 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4029
4030 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4031 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4032
4033 @table @code
4034 @item set backtrace past-main
4035 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4036 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4037
4038 @item set backtrace past-main off
4039 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4040 default.
4041
4042 @item show backtrace past-main
4043 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4044
4045 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4046 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4047 @cindex backtrace limit
4048 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4049 unlimited.
4050
4051 @item show backtrace limit
4052 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4053 @end table
4054
4055 @node Selection
4056 @section Selecting a frame
4057
4058 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4059 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4060 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4061 of the stack frame just selected.
4062
4063 @table @code
4064 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4065 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4066 @item frame @var{n}
4067 @itemx f @var{n}
4068 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4069 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4070 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4071 @code{main}.
4072
4073 @item frame @var{addr}
4074 @itemx f @var{addr}
4075 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4076 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4077 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4078 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4079 switches between them.
4080
4081 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4082 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4083
4084 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4085 pointer and a program counter.
4086
4087 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4088 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4089 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
4090 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
4091 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
4092
4093 @kindex up
4094 @item up @var{n}
4095 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4096 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4097 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4098
4099 @kindex down
4100 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4101 @item down @var{n}
4102 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4103 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4104 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4105 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4106 @end table
4107
4108 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4109 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4110 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4111 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4112
4113 @need 1000
4114 For example:
4115
4116 @smallexample
4117 @group
4118 (@value{GDBP}) up
4119 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4120 at env.c:10
4121 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4122 @end group
4123 @end smallexample
4124
4125 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4126 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4127 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4128 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4129 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4130 for details.
4131
4132 @table @code
4133 @kindex down-silently
4134 @kindex up-silently
4135 @item up-silently @var{n}
4136 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4137 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4138 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4139 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4140 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4141 distracting.
4142 @end table
4143
4144 @node Frame Info
4145 @section Information about a frame
4146
4147 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4148 stack frame.
4149
4150 @table @code
4151 @item frame
4152 @itemx f
4153 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4154 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4155 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4156 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4157 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4158
4159 @kindex info frame
4160 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4161 @item info frame
4162 @itemx info f
4163 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4164 including:
4165
4166 @itemize @bullet
4167 @item
4168 the address of the frame
4169 @item
4170 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4171 @item
4172 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4173 @item
4174 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4175 @item
4176 the address of the frame's arguments
4177 @item
4178 the address of the frame's local variables
4179 @item
4180 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4181 @item
4182 which registers were saved in the frame
4183 @end itemize
4184
4185 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4186 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4187 the usual conventions.
4188
4189 @item info frame @var{addr}
4190 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4191 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4192 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4193 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4194 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4195 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4196
4197 @kindex info args
4198 @item info args
4199 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4200
4201 @item info locals
4202 @kindex info locals
4203 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4204 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4205 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4206
4207 @kindex info catch
4208 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4209 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4210 @item info catch
4211 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4212 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4213 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4214 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4215 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4216
4217 @end table
4218
4219
4220 @node Source
4221 @chapter Examining Source Files
4222
4223 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4224 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4225 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4226 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4227 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4228 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4229 source files by explicit command.
4230
4231 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4232 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4233 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4234
4235 @menu
4236 * List:: Printing source lines
4237 * Edit:: Editing source files
4238 * Search:: Searching source files
4239 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4240 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4241 @end menu
4242
4243 @node List
4244 @section Printing source lines
4245
4246 @kindex list
4247 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4248 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4249 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4250 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4251
4252 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4253
4254 @table @code
4255 @item list @var{linenum}
4256 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4257 current source file.
4258
4259 @item list @var{function}
4260 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4261 @var{function}.
4262
4263 @item list
4264 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4265 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4266 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4267 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4268 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4269
4270 @item list -
4271 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4272 @end table
4273
4274 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4275 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4276
4277 @table @code
4278 @kindex set listsize
4279 @item set listsize @var{count}
4280 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4281 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4282
4283 @kindex show listsize
4284 @item show listsize
4285 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4286 @end table
4287
4288 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4289 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4290 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4291 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4292 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4293
4294 @cindex linespec
4295 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4296 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4297 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4298 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4299
4300 @table @code
4301 @item list @var{linespec}
4302 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4303
4304 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4305 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4306 linespecs.
4307
4308 @item list ,@var{last}
4309 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4310
4311 @item list @var{first},
4312 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4313
4314 @item list +
4315 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4316
4317 @item list -
4318 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4319
4320 @item list
4321 As described in the preceding table.
4322 @end table
4323
4324 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4325 kinds of linespec.
4326
4327 @table @code
4328 @item @var{number}
4329 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4330 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4331 the same source file as the first linespec.
4332
4333 @item +@var{offset}
4334 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4335 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4336 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4337 first linespec.
4338
4339 @item -@var{offset}
4340 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4341
4342 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4343 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4344
4345 @item @var{function}
4346 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4347 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4348
4349 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4350 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4351 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4352 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4353 identically named functions in different source files.
4354
4355 @item *@var{address}
4356 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4357 @var{address} may be any expression.
4358 @end table
4359
4360 @node Edit
4361 @section Editing source files
4362 @cindex editing source files
4363
4364 @kindex edit
4365 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4366 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4367 The editing program of your choice
4368 is invoked with the current line set to
4369 the active line in the program.
4370 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4371 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4372
4373 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4374
4375 @table @code
4376 @item edit
4377 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4378
4379 @item edit @var{number}
4380 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4381
4382 @item edit @var{function}
4383 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4384
4385 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4386 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4387
4388 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4389 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4390 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4391 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4392 identically named functions in different source files.
4393
4394 @item edit *@var{address}
4395 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4396 @var{address} may be any expression.
4397 @end table
4398
4399 @subsection Choosing your editor
4400 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4401 @footnote{
4402 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4403 following command-line syntax:
4404 @smallexample
4405 ex +@var{number} file
4406 @end smallexample
4407 The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4408 the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4409 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4410 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4411 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4412 @smallexample
4413 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4414 export EDITOR
4415 gdb ...
4416 @end smallexample
4417 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4418 @smallexample
4419 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4420 gdb ...
4421 @end smallexample
4422
4423 @node Search
4424 @section Searching source files
4425 @cindex searching
4426 @kindex reverse-search
4427
4428 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4429 regular expression.
4430
4431 @table @code
4432 @kindex search
4433 @kindex forward-search
4434 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4435 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4436 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4437 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4438 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4439 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4440 @code{fo}.
4441
4442 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4443 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4444 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4445 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4446 this command as @code{rev}.
4447 @end table
4448
4449 @node Source Path
4450 @section Specifying source directories
4451
4452 @cindex source path
4453 @cindex directories for source files
4454 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4455 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4456 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4457 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4458 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4459 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4460 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4461 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4462 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4463 path.
4464
4465 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4466 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4467 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4468 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4469 last resort.
4470
4471 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4472 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4473 each line is in the file.
4474
4475 @kindex directory
4476 @kindex dir
4477 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4478 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4479 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4480
4481 @table @code
4482 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4483 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4484 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4485 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4486 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4487 part of absolute file names) or
4488 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4489 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4490
4491 @kindex cdir
4492 @kindex cwd
4493 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4494 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4495 @cindex compilation directory
4496 @cindex current directory
4497 @cindex working directory
4498 @cindex directory, current
4499 @cindex directory, compilation
4500 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4501 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4502 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4503 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4504 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4505 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4506
4507 @item directory
4508 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4509
4510 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4511 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4512
4513 @item show directories
4514 @kindex show directories
4515 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4516 @end table
4517
4518 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4519 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4520 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4521
4522 @enumerate
4523 @item
4524 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4525
4526 @item
4527 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4528 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4529 directories in one command.
4530 @end enumerate
4531
4532 @node Machine Code
4533 @section Source and machine code
4534
4535 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4536 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4537 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4538 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4539 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4540 well as hex.
4541
4542 @table @code
4543 @kindex info line
4544 @item info line @var{linespec}
4545 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4546 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4547 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4548 source lines}).
4549 @end table
4550
4551 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4552 the object code for the first line of function
4553 @code{m4_changequote}:
4554
4555 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4556 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4557 @smallexample
4558 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4559 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4560 @end smallexample
4561
4562 @noindent
4563 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4564 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4565 @smallexample
4566 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4567 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4568 @end smallexample
4569
4570 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4571 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4572 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4573 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4574 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4575 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4576 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4577 variables}).
4578
4579 @table @code
4580 @kindex disassemble
4581 @cindex assembly instructions
4582 @cindex instructions, assembly
4583 @cindex machine instructions
4584 @cindex listing machine instructions
4585 @item disassemble
4586 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4587 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4588 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4589 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4590 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4591 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4592 @end table
4593
4594 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4595 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4596
4597 @smallexample
4598 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4599 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4600 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4601 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4602 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4603 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4604 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4605 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4606 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4607 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4608 End of assembler dump.
4609 @end smallexample
4610
4611 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4612 mnemonics or other syntax.
4613
4614 @table @code
4615 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4616 @cindex assembly instructions
4617 @cindex instructions, assembly
4618 @cindex machine instructions
4619 @cindex listing machine instructions
4620 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4621 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4622 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4623 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4624 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4625
4626 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4627 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4628 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4629 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4630 @end table
4631
4632
4633 @node Data
4634 @chapter Examining Data
4635
4636 @cindex printing data
4637 @cindex examining data
4638 @kindex print
4639 @kindex inspect
4640 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4641 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4642 @c different window or something like that.
4643 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4644 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4645 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4646 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4647 Different Languages}).
4648
4649 @table @code
4650 @item print @var{expr}
4651 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4652 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4653 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4654 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4655 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4656 formats}.
4657
4658 @item print
4659 @itemx print /@var{f}
4660 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4661 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4662 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4663 @end table
4664
4665 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4666 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4667 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4668
4669 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4670 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4671 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4672 Table}.
4673
4674 @menu
4675 * Expressions:: Expressions
4676 * Variables:: Program variables
4677 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4678 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4679 * Memory:: Examining memory
4680 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4681 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4682 * Value History:: Value history
4683 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4684 * Registers:: Registers
4685 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4686 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
4687 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4688 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
4689 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4690 character set than GDB does
4691 @end menu
4692
4693 @node Expressions
4694 @section Expressions
4695
4696 @cindex expressions
4697 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4698 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4699 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4700 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4701 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4702 you compiled your program to include this information; see
4703 @ref{Compilation}.
4704
4705 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4706 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4707 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4708 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4709
4710 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4711 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4712 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4713 languages.
4714
4715 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4716 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4717
4718 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4719 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4720 at that address in memory.
4721 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4722
4723 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4724 to programming languages:
4725
4726 @table @code
4727 @item @@
4728 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4729 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4730
4731 @item ::
4732 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4733 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4734
4735 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4736 @cindex type casting memory
4737 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4738 @cindex casts, to view memory
4739 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4740 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4741 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4742 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4743 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4744 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4745 @end table
4746
4747 @node Variables
4748 @section Program variables
4749
4750 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4751 in your program.
4752
4753 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4754 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4755
4756 @itemize @bullet
4757 @item
4758 global (or file-static)
4759 @end itemize
4760
4761 @noindent or
4762
4763 @itemize @bullet
4764 @item
4765 visible according to the scope rules of the
4766 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4767 @end itemize
4768
4769 @noindent This means that in the function
4770
4771 @smallexample
4772 foo (a)
4773 int a;
4774 @{
4775 bar (a);
4776 @{
4777 int b = test ();
4778 bar (b);
4779 @}
4780 @}
4781 @end smallexample
4782
4783 @noindent
4784 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4785 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4786 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4787 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4788
4789 @cindex variable name conflict
4790 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4791 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4792 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4793 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4794 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4795 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4796 using the colon-colon notation:
4797
4798 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4799 @iftex
4800 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4801 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4802 @end iftex
4803 @smallexample
4804 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4805 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4806 @end smallexample
4807
4808 @noindent
4809 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4810 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4811 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4812 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4813
4814 @smallexample
4815 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4816 @end smallexample
4817
4818 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4819 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4820 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4821 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4822 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4823 @c conflict?? --mew
4824
4825 @cindex wrong values
4826 @cindex variable values, wrong
4827 @quotation
4828 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4829 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4830 scope, and just before exit.
4831 @end quotation
4832 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4833 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4834 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4835 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4836 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4837 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4838 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4839 variable definitions may be gone.
4840
4841 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4842 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4843 when compiling.
4844
4845 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4846 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4847 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4848 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4849 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4850 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4851 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4852
4853 @smallexample
4854 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4855 @end smallexample
4856
4857 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4858 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4859 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4860 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4861 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4862 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4863 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4864 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
4865
4866
4867 @node Arrays
4868 @section Artificial arrays
4869
4870 @cindex artificial array
4871 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4872 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4873 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4874 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4875 program.
4876
4877 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4878 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4879 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4880 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4881 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4882 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4883 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4884 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4885 example. If a program says
4886
4887 @smallexample
4888 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4889 @end smallexample
4890
4891 @noindent
4892 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4893
4894 @smallexample
4895 p *array@@len
4896 @end smallexample
4897
4898 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4899 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4900 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4901 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4902 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4903
4904 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4905 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4906 The value need not be in memory:
4907 @smallexample
4908 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4909 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4910 @end smallexample
4911
4912 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4913 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4914 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4915 @smallexample
4916 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4917 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4918 @end smallexample
4919
4920 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4921 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4922 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4923 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4924 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4925 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4926 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4927 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4928 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4929 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4930
4931 @smallexample
4932 set $i = 0
4933 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4934 @key{RET}
4935 @key{RET}
4936 @dots{}
4937 @end smallexample
4938
4939 @node Output Formats
4940 @section Output formats
4941
4942 @cindex formatted output
4943 @cindex output formats
4944 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4945 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4946 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4947 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4948 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4949
4950 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4951 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4952 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4953 letters supported are:
4954
4955 @table @code
4956 @item x
4957 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4958 hexadecimal.
4959
4960 @item d
4961 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4962
4963 @item u
4964 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4965
4966 @item o
4967 Print as integer in octal.
4968
4969 @item t
4970 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4971 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4972 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4973 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4974
4975 @item a
4976 @cindex unknown address, locating
4977 @cindex locate address
4978 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4979 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4980 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4981
4982 @smallexample
4983 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4984 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4985 @end smallexample
4986
4987 @noindent
4988 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4989 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4990
4991 @item c
4992 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4993
4994 @item f
4995 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4996 using typical floating point syntax.
4997 @end table
4998
4999 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5000
5001 @smallexample
5002 p/x $pc
5003 @end smallexample
5004
5005 @noindent
5006 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5007 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5008
5009 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5010 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5011 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5012
5013 @node Memory
5014 @section Examining memory
5015
5016 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5017 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5018
5019 @cindex examining memory
5020 @table @code
5021 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5022 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5023 @itemx x @var{addr}
5024 @itemx x
5025 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5026 @end table
5027
5028 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5029 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5030 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5031 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5032 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5033
5034 @table @r
5035 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5036 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5037 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5038 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5039 @c 4.1.2.
5040
5041 @item @var{f}, the display format
5042 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
5043 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
5044 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
5045 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5046
5047 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5048 The unit size is any of
5049
5050 @table @code
5051 @item b
5052 Bytes.
5053 @item h
5054 Halfwords (two bytes).
5055 @item w
5056 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5057 @item g
5058 Giant words (eight bytes).
5059 @end table
5060
5061 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5062 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5063 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5064
5065 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5066 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5067 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5068 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5069 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5070 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5071 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5072 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5073 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5074 a value from memory).
5075 @end table
5076
5077 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5078 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5079 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5080 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5081 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5082
5083 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5084 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5085 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5086 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5087 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5088
5089 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5090 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5091 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5092 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5093 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5094 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5095
5096 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5097 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5098 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5099 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5100 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5101 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5102 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5103
5104 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5105 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5106 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5107 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5108 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5109 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5110 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5111 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5112 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5113
5114 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5115 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5116 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5117
5118 @node Auto Display
5119 @section Automatic display
5120 @cindex automatic display
5121 @cindex display of expressions
5122
5123 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5124 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5125 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5126 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5127 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5128 The automatic display looks like this:
5129
5130 @smallexample
5131 2: foo = 38
5132 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5133 @end smallexample
5134
5135 @noindent
5136 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5137 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5138 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5139 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5140 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5141 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5142 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5143
5144 @table @code
5145 @kindex display
5146 @item display @var{expr}
5147 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5148 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5149
5150 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5151
5152 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5153 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5154 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5155 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5156 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5157
5158 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5159 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5160 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5161 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5162 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5163 @end table
5164
5165 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5166 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5167 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5168
5169 @table @code
5170 @kindex delete display
5171 @kindex undisplay
5172 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5173 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5174 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5175
5176 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5177 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5178
5179 @kindex disable display
5180 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5181 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5182 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5183 enabled again later.
5184
5185 @kindex enable display
5186 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5187 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5188 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5189
5190 @item display
5191 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5192 done when your program stops.
5193
5194 @kindex info display
5195 @item info display
5196 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5197 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5198 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5199 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5200 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5201 @end table
5202
5203 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5204 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5205 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5206 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5207 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5208 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5209 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5210 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5211 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5212 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5213
5214 @node Print Settings
5215 @section Print settings
5216
5217 @cindex format options
5218 @cindex print settings
5219 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5220 and symbols are printed.
5221
5222 @noindent
5223 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5224
5225 @table @code
5226 @kindex set print address
5227 @item set print address
5228 @itemx set print address on
5229 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5230 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5231 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5232 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5233 @code{set print address on}:
5234
5235 @smallexample
5236 @group
5237 (@value{GDBP}) f
5238 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5239 at input.c:530
5240 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5241 @end group
5242 @end smallexample
5243
5244 @item set print address off
5245 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5246 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5247
5248 @smallexample
5249 @group
5250 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5251 (@value{GDBP}) f
5252 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5253 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5254 @end group
5255 @end smallexample
5256
5257 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5258 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5259 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5260 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5261
5262 @kindex show print address
5263 @item show print address
5264 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5265 @end table
5266
5267 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5268 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5269 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5270 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5271 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5272 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5273 it prints a symbolic address:
5274
5275 @table @code
5276 @kindex set print symbol-filename
5277 @item set print symbol-filename on
5278 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5279 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5280
5281 @item set print symbol-filename off
5282 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5283 default.
5284
5285 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5286 @item show print symbol-filename
5287 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5288 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5289 @end table
5290
5291 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5292 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5293 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5294
5295 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5296 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5297
5298 @table @code
5299 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5300 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5301 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5302 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5303 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5304 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5305
5306 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5307 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5308 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5309 symbolic address.
5310 @end table
5311
5312 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5313 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5314 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5315 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5316 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5317 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5318 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5319 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5320
5321 @smallexample
5322 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5323 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5324 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5325 @end smallexample
5326
5327 @quotation
5328 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5329 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5330 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5331 @end quotation
5332
5333 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5334
5335 @table @code
5336 @kindex set print array
5337 @item set print array
5338 @itemx set print array on
5339 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5340 but uses more space. The default is off.
5341
5342 @item set print array off
5343 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5344
5345 @kindex show print array
5346 @item show print array
5347 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5348 arrays.
5349
5350 @kindex set print elements
5351 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5352 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5353 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5354 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5355 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5356 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5357 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5358
5359 @kindex show print elements
5360 @item show print elements
5361 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5362 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5363
5364 @kindex set print null-stop
5365 @item set print null-stop
5366 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5367 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5368 contain only short strings.
5369 The default is off.
5370
5371 @kindex set print pretty
5372 @item set print pretty on
5373 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5374 per line, like this:
5375
5376 @smallexample
5377 @group
5378 $1 = @{
5379 next = 0x0,
5380 flags = @{
5381 sweet = 1,
5382 sour = 1
5383 @},
5384 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5385 @}
5386 @end group
5387 @end smallexample
5388
5389 @item set print pretty off
5390 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5391
5392 @smallexample
5393 @group
5394 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5395 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5396 @end group
5397 @end smallexample
5398
5399 @noindent
5400 This is the default format.
5401
5402 @kindex show print pretty
5403 @item show print pretty
5404 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5405
5406 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5407 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5408 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5409 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5410 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5411 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5412 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5413
5414 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5415 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5416 international character sets, and is the default.
5417
5418 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5419 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5420 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5421
5422 @kindex set print union
5423 @item set print union on
5424 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5425 is the default setting.
5426
5427 @item set print union off
5428 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5429
5430 @kindex show print union
5431 @item show print union
5432 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5433 structures.
5434
5435 For example, given the declarations
5436
5437 @smallexample
5438 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5439 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5440 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5441 Bug_forms;
5442
5443 struct thing @{
5444 Species it;
5445 union @{
5446 Tree_forms tree;
5447 Bug_forms bug;
5448 @} form;
5449 @};
5450
5451 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5452 @end smallexample
5453
5454 @noindent
5455 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5456
5457 @smallexample
5458 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5459 @end smallexample
5460
5461 @noindent
5462 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5463
5464 @smallexample
5465 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5466 @end smallexample
5467 @end table
5468
5469 @need 1000
5470 @noindent
5471 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5472
5473 @table @code
5474 @cindex demangling
5475 @kindex set print demangle
5476 @item set print demangle
5477 @itemx set print demangle on
5478 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5479 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5480 linkage. The default is on.
5481
5482 @kindex show print demangle
5483 @item show print demangle
5484 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5485
5486 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5487 @item set print asm-demangle
5488 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5489 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5490 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5491 The default is off.
5492
5493 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5494 @item show print asm-demangle
5495 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5496 or demangled form.
5497
5498 @kindex set demangle-style
5499 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5500 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5501 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5502 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5503 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5504
5505 @table @code
5506 @item auto
5507 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5508
5509 @item gnu
5510 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5511 This is the default.
5512
5513 @item hp
5514 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5515
5516 @item lucid
5517 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5518
5519 @item arm
5520 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5521 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5522 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5523 require further enhancement to permit that.
5524
5525 @end table
5526 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5527
5528 @kindex show demangle-style
5529 @item show demangle-style
5530 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5531
5532 @kindex set print object
5533 @item set print object
5534 @itemx set print object on
5535 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5536 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5537 the virtual function table.
5538
5539 @item set print object off
5540 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5541 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5542
5543 @kindex show print object
5544 @item show print object
5545 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5546
5547 @kindex set print static-members
5548 @item set print static-members
5549 @itemx set print static-members on
5550 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5551
5552 @item set print static-members off
5553 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5554
5555 @kindex show print static-members
5556 @item show print static-members
5557 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5558
5559 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5560 @kindex set print vtbl
5561 @item set print vtbl
5562 @itemx set print vtbl on
5563 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5564 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5565 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5566
5567 @item set print vtbl off
5568 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5569
5570 @kindex show print vtbl
5571 @item show print vtbl
5572 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5573 @end table
5574
5575 @node Value History
5576 @section Value history
5577
5578 @cindex value history
5579 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5580 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5581 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5582 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5583 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5584 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5585 symbol table.
5586
5587 @cindex @code{$}
5588 @cindex @code{$$}
5589 @cindex history number
5590 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5591 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5592 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5593 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5594 history number.
5595
5596 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5597 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5598 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5599 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5600 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5601 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5602 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5603
5604 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5605 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5606
5607 @smallexample
5608 p *$
5609 @end smallexample
5610
5611 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5612 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5613
5614 @smallexample
5615 p *$.next
5616 @end smallexample
5617
5618 @noindent
5619 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5620 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5621
5622 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5623 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5624
5625 @smallexample
5626 print x
5627 set x=5
5628 @end smallexample
5629
5630 @noindent
5631 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5632 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5633
5634 @table @code
5635 @kindex show values
5636 @item show values
5637 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5638 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5639 values} does not change the history.
5640
5641 @item show values @var{n}
5642 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5643
5644 @item show values +
5645 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5646 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5647 @end table
5648
5649 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5650 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5651
5652 @node Convenience Vars
5653 @section Convenience variables
5654
5655 @cindex convenience variables
5656 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5657 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5658 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5659 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5660 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5661
5662 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5663 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5664 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5665 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5666 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5667
5668 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5669 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5670 For example:
5671
5672 @smallexample
5673 set $foo = *object_ptr
5674 @end smallexample
5675
5676 @noindent
5677 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5678 @code{object_ptr}.
5679
5680 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5681 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5682 value with another assignment at any time.
5683
5684 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5685 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5686 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5687 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5688
5689 @table @code
5690 @kindex show convenience
5691 @item show convenience
5692 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5693 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5694 @end table
5695
5696 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5697 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5698 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5699
5700 @smallexample
5701 set $i = 0
5702 print bar[$i++]->contents
5703 @end smallexample
5704
5705 @noindent
5706 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5707
5708 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5709 values likely to be useful.
5710
5711 @table @code
5712 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5713 @item $_
5714 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5715 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5716 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5717 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5718 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5719 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5720 to the type of @code{$__}.
5721
5722 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5723 @item $__
5724 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5725 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5726 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5727
5728 @item $_exitcode
5729 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5730 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5731 the program being debugged terminates.
5732 @end table
5733
5734 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5735 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5736 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5737
5738 @node Registers
5739 @section Registers
5740
5741 @cindex registers
5742 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5743 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5744 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5745 your machine.
5746
5747 @table @code
5748 @kindex info registers
5749 @item info registers
5750 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5751 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5752
5753 @kindex info all-registers
5754 @cindex floating point registers
5755 @item info all-registers
5756 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5757 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5758
5759 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5760 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5761 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5762 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5763 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5764 @end table
5765
5766 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5767 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5768 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5769 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5770 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5771 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5772 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5773 you could print the program counter in hex with
5774
5775 @smallexample
5776 p/x $pc
5777 @end smallexample
5778
5779 @noindent
5780 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5781
5782 @smallexample
5783 x/i $pc
5784 @end smallexample
5785
5786 @noindent
5787 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5788 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5789 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5790 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5791 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5792 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5793 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5794
5795 @smallexample
5796 set $sp += 4
5797 @end smallexample
5798
5799 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5800 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5801 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5802 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5803 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5804 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5805 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5806
5807 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5808 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5809 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5810 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5811 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5812 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5813 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5814
5815 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5816 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5817 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5818 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5819 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5820 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5821 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5822 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5823 prints the data in both formats.
5824
5825 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5826 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5827 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5828 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5829 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5830 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5831
5832 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5833 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5834 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5835 frame makes no difference.
5836
5837 @node Floating Point Hardware
5838 @section Floating point hardware
5839 @cindex floating point
5840
5841 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5842 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5843
5844 @table @code
5845 @kindex info float
5846 @item info float
5847 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5848 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5849 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5850 the ARM and x86 machines.
5851 @end table
5852
5853 @node Vector Unit
5854 @section Vector Unit
5855 @cindex vector unit
5856
5857 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5858 more information about the status of the vector unit.
5859
5860 @table @code
5861 @kindex info vector
5862 @item info vector
5863 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5864 layout vary depending on the hardware.
5865 @end table
5866
5867 @node Memory Region Attributes
5868 @section Memory region attributes
5869 @cindex memory region attributes
5870
5871 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5872 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5873 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5874 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5875
5876 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5877 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5878 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5879 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5880 all memory.
5881
5882 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5883 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5884
5885 @table @code
5886 @kindex mem
5887 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5888 Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5889 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5890 special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5891 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
5892
5893 @kindex delete mem
5894 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5895 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5896
5897 @kindex disable mem
5898 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5899 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5900 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5901 It may be enabled again later.
5902
5903 @kindex enable mem
5904 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5905 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5906
5907 @kindex info mem
5908 @item info mem
5909 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5910 for each region.
5911
5912 @table @emph
5913 @item Memory Region Number
5914 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5915 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5916 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5917
5918 @item Lo Address
5919 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5920
5921 @item Hi Address
5922 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5923
5924 @item Attributes
5925 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5926 @end table
5927 @end table
5928
5929
5930 @subsection Attributes
5931
5932 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5933 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5934 write accesses to a memory region.
5935
5936 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5937 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5938 etc. from accessing memory.
5939
5940 @table @code
5941 @item ro
5942 Memory is read only.
5943 @item wo
5944 Memory is write only.
5945 @item rw
5946 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5947 @end table
5948
5949 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5950 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5951 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5952 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5953 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5954
5955 @table @code
5956 @item 8
5957 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5958 @item 16
5959 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5960 @item 32
5961 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5962 @item 64
5963 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5964 @end table
5965
5966 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5967 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5968 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5969 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5970 @c
5971 @c @table @code
5972 @c @item hwbreak
5973 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5974 @c @item swbreak (default)
5975 @c @end table
5976
5977 @subsubsection Data Cache
5978 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5979 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5980 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5981 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5982 registers.
5983
5984 @table @code
5985 @item cache
5986 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5987 @item nocache
5988 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5989 @end table
5990
5991 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5992 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5993 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5994 @c
5995 @c @table @code
5996 @c @item verify
5997 @c @item noverify (default)
5998 @c @end table
5999
6000 @node Dump/Restore Files
6001 @section Copy between memory and a file
6002 @cindex dump/restore files
6003 @cindex append data to a file
6004 @cindex dump data to a file
6005 @cindex restore data from a file
6006
6007 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6008 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6009 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6010 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6011 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6012 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6013 files.
6014
6015 @table @code
6016
6017 @kindex dump
6018 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6019 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6020 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6021 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6022
6023 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6024 @table @code
6025 @item binary
6026 Raw binary form.
6027 @item ihex
6028 Intel hex format.
6029 @item srec
6030 Motorola S-record format.
6031 @item tekhex
6032 Tektronix Hex format.
6033 @end table
6034
6035 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6036 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6037 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6038 form.
6039
6040 @kindex append
6041 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6042 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6043 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6044 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6045 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6046
6047 @kindex restore
6048 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6049 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6050 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6051 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6052 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6053
6054 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6055 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6056 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6057 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6058 from that location.
6059
6060 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6061 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6062 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6063 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6064
6065 @end table
6066
6067 @node Character Sets
6068 @section Character Sets
6069 @cindex character sets
6070 @cindex charset
6071 @cindex translating between character sets
6072 @cindex host character set
6073 @cindex target character set
6074
6075 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6076 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6077 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6078 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6079 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6080 @dfn{target character set}.
6081
6082 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6083 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6084 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6085 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6086 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6087 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
6088 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
6089 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6090 character and string literals in expressions.
6091
6092 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6093 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6094 target-charset} command, described below.
6095
6096 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6097 support:
6098
6099 @table @code
6100 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
6101 @kindex set target-charset
6102 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
6103 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
6104 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6105 list the target character sets it supports.
6106 @end table
6107
6108 @table @code
6109 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
6110 @kindex set host-charset
6111 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6112
6113 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6114 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6115 @code{set host-charset} command.
6116
6117 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6118 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
6119 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6120 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6121 list the host character sets it supports.
6122
6123 @item set charset @var{charset}
6124 @kindex set charset
6125 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6126 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6127 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6128 for both host and target.
6129
6130
6131 @item show charset
6132 @kindex show charset
6133 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6134
6135 @itemx show host-charset
6136 @kindex show host-charset
6137 Show the name of the current host charset.
6138
6139 @itemx show target-charset
6140 @kindex show target-charset
6141 Show the name of the current target charset.
6142
6143 @end table
6144
6145 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6146 sets:
6147
6148 @table @code
6149
6150 @item ASCII
6151 @cindex ASCII character set
6152 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6153 character set.
6154
6155 @item ISO-8859-1
6156 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6157 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6158 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
6159 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6160 this as its host character set.
6161
6162 @item EBCDIC-US
6163 @itemx IBM1047
6164 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6165 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6166 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6167 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6168 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6169
6170 @end table
6171
6172 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6173 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6174 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6175
6176 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6177 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6178 @file{charset-test.c}:
6179
6180 @smallexample
6181 #include <stdio.h>
6182
6183 char ascii_hello[]
6184 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6185 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6186 char ibm1047_hello[]
6187 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6188 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6189
6190 main ()
6191 @{
6192 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6193 @}
6194 @end smallexample
6195
6196 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6197 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6198 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6199
6200 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6201
6202 @smallexample
6203 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6204 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6205 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6206 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6207 @dots{}
6208 (gdb)
6209 @end smallexample
6210
6211 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6212 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6213 strings:
6214
6215 @smallexample
6216 (gdb) show charset
6217 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
6218 (gdb)
6219 @end smallexample
6220
6221 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6222 initial character set:
6223 @smallexample
6224 (gdb) set charset ASCII
6225 (gdb) show charset
6226 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
6227 (gdb)
6228 @end smallexample
6229
6230 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6231 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6232 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6233 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6234 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6235
6236 @smallexample
6237 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6238 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6239 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6240 $2 = 72 'H'
6241 (gdb)
6242 @end smallexample
6243
6244 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6245 literals you use in expressions:
6246
6247 @smallexample
6248 (gdb) print '+'
6249 $3 = 43 '+'
6250 (gdb)
6251 @end smallexample
6252
6253 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6254 character.
6255
6256 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6257 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6258 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6259
6260 @smallexample
6261 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6262 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6263 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6264 $5 = 200 '\310'
6265 (gdb)
6266 @end smallexample
6267
6268 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6269 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6270
6271 @smallexample
6272 (gdb) set target-charset
6273 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
6274 (gdb) set target-charset
6275 @end smallexample
6276
6277 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6278 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6279 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6280 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6281 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6282
6283 @smallexample
6284 (gdb) set target-charset IBM1047
6285 (gdb) show charset
6286 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
6287 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
6288 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6289 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6290 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6291 $7 = 72 '\110'
6292 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6293 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6294 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6295 $9 = 200 'H'
6296 (gdb)
6297 @end smallexample
6298
6299 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6300 string literals you use in expressions:
6301
6302 @smallexample
6303 (gdb) print '+'
6304 $10 = 78 '+'
6305 (gdb)
6306 @end smallexample
6307
6308 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6309 character.
6310
6311
6312 @node Macros
6313 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6314
6315 Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6316 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6317 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6318 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6319 where it was defined.
6320
6321 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6322 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6323 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6324 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6325
6326 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6327 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6328 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6329 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6330 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6331 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6332 see @ref{List}.
6333
6334 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6335 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6336 variable-arity macros.
6337
6338 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6339 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6340 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6341
6342 @table @code
6343
6344 @kindex macro expand
6345 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6346 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6347 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6348 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6349 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6350 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6351 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6352 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6353 it can be any string of tokens.
6354
6355 @kindex macro expand-once
6356 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6357 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6358 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6359 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6360 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6361 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6362 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6363 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6364 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6365 can be any string of tokens.
6366
6367 @kindex info macro
6368 @cindex macro definition, showing
6369 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6370 @item info macro @var{macro}
6371 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6372 source location where that definition was established.
6373
6374 @kindex macro define
6375 @cindex user-defined macros
6376 @cindex defining macros interactively
6377 @cindex macros, user-defined
6378 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6379 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6380 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6381 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6382 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6383 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6384 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6385 given in @var{arglist}.
6386
6387 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6388 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6389 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6390 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6391 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6392
6393 @kindex macro undef
6394 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6395 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6396 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6397 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6398 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6399 debugged.
6400
6401 @end table
6402
6403 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6404 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6405 show our source files:
6406
6407 @smallexample
6408 $ cat sample.c
6409 #include <stdio.h>
6410 #include "sample.h"
6411
6412 #define M 42
6413 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6414
6415 main ()
6416 @{
6417 #define N 28
6418 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6419 #undef N
6420 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6421 #define N 1729
6422 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6423 @}
6424 $ cat sample.h
6425 #define Q <
6426 $
6427 @end smallexample
6428
6429 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6430 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6431 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6432 information.
6433
6434 @smallexample
6435 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6436 $
6437 @end smallexample
6438
6439 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6440
6441 @smallexample
6442 $ gdb -nw sample
6443 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6444 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6445 GDB is free software, @dots{}
6446 (gdb)
6447 @end smallexample
6448
6449 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6450 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6451 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6452
6453 @smallexample
6454 (gdb) list main
6455 3
6456 4 #define M 42
6457 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6458 6
6459 7 main ()
6460 8 @{
6461 9 #define N 28
6462 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6463 11 #undef N
6464 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6465 (gdb) info macro ADD
6466 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6467 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6468 (gdb) info macro Q
6469 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6470 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6471 #define Q <
6472 (gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6473 expands to: (42 + 1)
6474 (gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6475 expands to: once (M + 1)
6476 (gdb)
6477 @end smallexample
6478
6479 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6480 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6481 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6482 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6483
6484 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6485 the source line of the current stack frame:
6486
6487 @smallexample
6488 (gdb) break main
6489 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6490 (gdb) run
6491 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6492
6493 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
6494 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6495 (gdb)
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6499
6500 @smallexample
6501 (gdb) info macro N
6502 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6503 #define N 28
6504 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6505 expands to: 28 < 42
6506 (gdb) print N Q M
6507 $1 = 1
6508 (gdb)
6509 @end smallexample
6510
6511 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6512 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6513 thereof) in force at each point:
6514
6515 @smallexample
6516 (gdb) next
6517 Hello, world!
6518 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6519 (gdb) info macro N
6520 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6521 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6522 (gdb) next
6523 We're so creative.
6524 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6525 (gdb) info macro N
6526 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6527 #define N 1729
6528 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6529 expands to: 1729 < 42
6530 (gdb) print N Q M
6531 $2 = 0
6532 (gdb)
6533 @end smallexample
6534
6535
6536 @node Tracepoints
6537 @chapter Tracepoints
6538 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6539 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6540
6541 @cindex tracepoints
6542 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6543 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6544 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6545 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6546 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6547 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6548 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6549
6550 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6551 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6552 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6553 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6554 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6555 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6556 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6557 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6558 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6559 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6560 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6561
6562 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
6563 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6564 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6565 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6566 tracepoints as of this writing.
6567
6568 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6569
6570 @menu
6571 * Set Tracepoints::
6572 * Analyze Collected Data::
6573 * Tracepoint Variables::
6574 @end menu
6575
6576 @node Set Tracepoints
6577 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6578
6579 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6580 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6581 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6582 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6583 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6584 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6585 work on.
6586
6587 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6588 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6589 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6590 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6591 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6592 tracepoint was hit.
6593
6594 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6595 conditions and actions.
6596
6597 @menu
6598 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6599 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6600 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
6601 * Tracepoint Actions::
6602 * Listing Tracepoints::
6603 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6604 @end menu
6605
6606 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6607 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6608
6609 @table @code
6610 @cindex set tracepoint
6611 @kindex trace
6612 @item trace
6613 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6614 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6615 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6616 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6617 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6618 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6619 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6620 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6621 running.
6622
6623 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6624
6625 @smallexample
6626 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6627
6628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6629
6630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6631
6632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6633
6634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6635 @end smallexample
6636
6637 @noindent
6638 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6639
6640 @vindex $tpnum
6641 @cindex last tracepoint number
6642 @cindex recent tracepoint number
6643 @cindex tracepoint number
6644 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6645 of the most recently set tracepoint.
6646
6647 @kindex delete tracepoint
6648 @cindex tracepoint deletion
6649 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6650 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6651 default is to delete all tracepoints.
6652
6653 Examples:
6654
6655 @smallexample
6656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6657
6658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6659 @end smallexample
6660
6661 @noindent
6662 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6663 @end table
6664
6665 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6666 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6667
6668 @table @code
6669 @kindex disable tracepoint
6670 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6671 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6672 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6673 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6674 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6675
6676 @kindex enable tracepoint
6677 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6678 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6679 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6680 run.
6681 @end table
6682
6683 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
6684 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6685
6686 @table @code
6687 @kindex passcount
6688 @cindex tracepoint pass count
6689 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6690 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6691 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6692 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6693 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6694 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6695 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6696 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6697 user.
6698
6699 Examples:
6700
6701 @smallexample
6702 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6703 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
6704
6705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6706 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
6707 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6709 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6713 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6714 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6715 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
6716 @end smallexample
6717 @end table
6718
6719 @node Tracepoint Actions
6720 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6721
6722 @table @code
6723 @kindex actions
6724 @cindex tracepoint actions
6725 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6726 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6727 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6728 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6729 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6730 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6731 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6732 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6733 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6734 @code{while-stepping}.
6735
6736 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6737 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6738 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6739
6740 @smallexample
6741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6742
6743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
6744
6745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
6746 @end smallexample
6747
6748 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6749 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6750 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6751 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6752 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6753 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6754 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6755 @code{end} command.
6756
6757 @smallexample
6758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6760 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6761 > collect bar,baz
6762 > collect $regs
6763 > while-stepping 12
6764 > collect $fp, $sp
6765 > end
6766 end
6767 @end smallexample
6768
6769 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6770 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6771 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6772 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6773 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6774 special arguments are supported:
6775
6776 @table @code
6777 @item $regs
6778 collect all registers
6779
6780 @item $args
6781 collect all function arguments
6782
6783 @item $locals
6784 collect all local variables.
6785 @end table
6786
6787 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6788 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6789 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6790
6791 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6792 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6793
6794 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6795 @item while-stepping @var{n}
6796 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6797 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6798 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6799 its own @code{end} command):
6800
6801 @smallexample
6802 > while-stepping 12
6803 > collect $regs, myglobal
6804 > end
6805 >
6806 @end smallexample
6807
6808 @noindent
6809 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6810 @code{stepping}.
6811 @end table
6812
6813 @node Listing Tracepoints
6814 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
6815
6816 @table @code
6817 @kindex info tracepoints
6818 @cindex information about tracepoints
6819 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6820 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
6821 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
6822 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6823 shown:
6824
6825 @itemize @bullet
6826 @item
6827 its number
6828 @item
6829 whether it is enabled or disabled
6830 @item
6831 its address
6832 @item
6833 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6834 @item
6835 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6836 @item
6837 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6838 @item
6839 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6840 @end itemize
6841
6842 @smallexample
6843 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6844 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6845 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6846 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6847 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6848 (@value{GDBP})
6849 @end smallexample
6850
6851 @noindent
6852 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6853 @end table
6854
6855 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6856 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6857
6858 @table @code
6859 @kindex tstart
6860 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6861 @cindex collected data discarded
6862 @item tstart
6863 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6864 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6865 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6866 experiment.
6867
6868 @kindex tstop
6869 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6870 @item tstop
6871 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6872 stops collecting data.
6873
6874 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6875 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6876 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6877
6878 @kindex tstatus
6879 @cindex status of trace data collection
6880 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6881 @item tstatus
6882 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6883 collection.
6884 @end table
6885
6886 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6887
6888 @smallexample
6889 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6890 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6891 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6892 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6893 > while-stepping 11
6894 > collect $regs
6895 > end
6896 > end
6897 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6898 [time passes @dots{}]
6899 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6900 @end smallexample
6901
6902
6903 @node Analyze Collected Data
6904 @section Using the collected data
6905
6906 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6907 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6908 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6909 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6910 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6911 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6912 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6913 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6914 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6915 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6916 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6917 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6918 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6919 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6920 the buffer will fail.
6921
6922 @menu
6923 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6924 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6925 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6926 @end menu
6927
6928 @node tfind
6929 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6930
6931 @kindex tfind
6932 @cindex select trace snapshot
6933 @cindex find trace snapshot
6934 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6935 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6936 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6937 snapshot is selected.
6938
6939 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6940
6941 @table @code
6942 @item tfind start
6943 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6944 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6945
6946 @item tfind none
6947 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6948
6949 @item tfind end
6950 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6951
6952 @item tfind
6953 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6954
6955 @item tfind -
6956 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6957 retracing earlier steps.
6958
6959 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6960 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6961 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6962 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6963 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6964
6965 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6966 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6967 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6968 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6969 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6970
6971 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6972 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6973 addresses.
6974
6975 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6976 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6977 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6978
6979 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6980 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6981 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6982 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6983 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6984 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6985 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6986 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6987 @end table
6988
6989 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6990 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6991 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6992 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6993 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6994 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6995 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6996 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6997 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6998 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6999 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7000 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7001 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7002 tracepoint as the current one.
7003
7004 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7005 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7006 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7007 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7008 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7009
7010 @smallexample
7011 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7013 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7014 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7015 > tfind
7016 > end
7017
7018 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7019 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7020 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7021 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7022 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7023 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
7024 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
7025 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
7026 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
7027 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
7028 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
7029 @end smallexample
7030
7031 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
7032 the buffer:
7033
7034 @smallexample
7035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7036 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7037 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
7038 > tfind line
7039 > end
7040
7041 Frame 0, X = 1
7042 Frame 7, X = 2
7043 Frame 13, X = 255
7044 @end smallexample
7045
7046 @node tdump
7047 @subsection @code{tdump}
7048 @kindex tdump
7049 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7050 @cindex tracepoint data, display
7051
7052 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7053 the current trace snapshot.
7054
7055 @smallexample
7056 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7057 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7058 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7059 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7060 > end
7061
7062 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7063
7064 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
7065 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
7066 at gdb_test.c:444
7067 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
7068
7069 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
7070 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
7071 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
7072 d1 0x18 24
7073 d2 0x80 128
7074 d3 0x33 51
7075 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
7076 d5 0x22 34
7077 d6 0xe0 224
7078 d7 0x380035 3670069
7079 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
7080 a1 0x3000668 50333288
7081 a2 0x100 256
7082 a3 0x322000 3284992
7083 a4 0x3000698 50333336
7084 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
7085 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
7086 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
7087 ps 0x0 0
7088 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
7089 fpcontrol 0x0 0
7090 fpstatus 0x0 0
7091 fpiaddr 0x0 0
7092 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
7093 p1 = (void *) 0x11
7094 p2 = (void *) 0x22
7095 p3 = (void *) 0x33
7096 p4 = (void *) 0x44
7097 p5 = (void *) 0x55
7098 p6 = (void *) 0x66
7099 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
7100
7101 (@value{GDBP})
7102 @end smallexample
7103
7104 @node save-tracepoints
7105 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
7106 @kindex save-tracepoints
7107 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
7108
7109 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7110 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7111 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7112 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7113 Files}).
7114
7115 @node Tracepoint Variables
7116 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7117 @cindex tracepoint variables
7118 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7119
7120 @table @code
7121 @vindex $trace_frame
7122 @item (int) $trace_frame
7123 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7124 snapshot is selected.
7125
7126 @vindex $tracepoint
7127 @item (int) $tracepoint
7128 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7129
7130 @vindex $trace_line
7131 @item (int) $trace_line
7132 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7133
7134 @vindex $trace_file
7135 @item (char []) $trace_file
7136 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7137
7138 @vindex $trace_func
7139 @item (char []) $trace_func
7140 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7141 @end table
7142
7143 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7144 use @code{output} instead.
7145
7146 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7147 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7148 data.
7149
7150 @smallexample
7151 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7152
7153 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7154 > output $trace_file
7155 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7156 > tfind
7157 > end
7158 @end smallexample
7159
7160 @node Overlays
7161 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7162 @cindex overlays
7163
7164 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7165 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7166 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7167 use overlays.
7168
7169 @menu
7170 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7171 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7172 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7173 mapped by asking the inferior.
7174 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7175 @end menu
7176
7177 @node How Overlays Work
7178 @section How Overlays Work
7179 @cindex mapped overlays
7180 @cindex unmapped overlays
7181 @cindex load address, overlay's
7182 @cindex mapped address
7183 @cindex overlay area
7184
7185 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7186 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7187 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7188 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7189 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7190
7191 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7192 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7193 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7194 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7195 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7196 largest overlay as well.
7197
7198 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7199 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7200 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7201 there.
7202
7203 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7204 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7205 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7206
7207 @smallexample
7208 @group
7209 Data Instruction Larger
7210 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7211 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7212 | | | | | |
7213 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7214 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7215 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7216 | and heap | | | | | |
7217 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7218 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7219 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7220 | | | | | |
7221 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7222 address | | | | | |
7223 | overlay | <-' | | |
7224 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7225 | | <---. | | load address
7226 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7227 | | | |
7228 +-----------+ | |
7229 +-----------+
7230 | |
7231 +-----------+
7232
7233 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7234 @end group
7235 @end smallexample
7236
7237 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7238 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7239 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7240 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7241 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7242 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7243 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7244 program and the overlay area.
7245
7246 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7247 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7248 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7249 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7250 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7251 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7252 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7253
7254 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7255 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7256 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7257
7258 @itemize @bullet
7259
7260 @item
7261 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7262 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7263 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7264 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7265
7266 @item
7267 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7268 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7269 your program's performance.
7270
7271 @item
7272 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7273 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7274 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7275 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7276 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7277 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7278 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7279
7280 @item
7281 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7282 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7283 instruction and data spaces.
7284
7285 @end itemize
7286
7287 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7288 improved in many ways:
7289
7290 @itemize @bullet
7291
7292 @item
7293 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7294 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7295 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7296 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7297 area in the usual way.
7298
7299 @item
7300 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7301 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7302
7303 @item
7304 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7305 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7306 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7307 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7308 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7309 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7310 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7311
7312 @end itemize
7313
7314
7315 @node Overlay Commands
7316 @section Overlay Commands
7317
7318 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7319 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7320 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7321 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7322 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7323 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7324
7325 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7326 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7327
7328 @table @code
7329 @item overlay off
7330 @kindex overlay off
7331 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7332 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7333 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7334 overlay support is disabled.
7335
7336 @item overlay manual
7337 @kindex overlay manual
7338 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7339 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7340 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7341 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7342 commands described below.
7343
7344 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7345 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7346 @kindex overlay map-overlay
7347 @cindex map an overlay
7348 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7349 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7350 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7351 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7352 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7353 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7354
7355 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7356 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7357 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7358 @cindex unmap an overlay
7359 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7360 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7361 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7362 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7363
7364 @item overlay auto
7365 @kindex overlay auto
7366 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7367 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7368 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7369 Overlay Debugging}.
7370
7371 @item overlay load-target
7372 @itemx overlay load
7373 @kindex overlay load-target
7374 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7375 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7376 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7377 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7378 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7379 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7380
7381 @item overlay list-overlays
7382 @itemx overlay list
7383 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7384 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7385 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7386
7387 @end table
7388
7389 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7390 of the function the address falls in:
7391
7392 @smallexample
7393 (gdb) print main
7394 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7395 @end smallexample
7396 @noindent
7397 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7398 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7399 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7400 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7401
7402 @smallexample
7403 (gdb) overlay list
7404 No sections are mapped.
7405 (gdb) print foo
7406 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7407 @end smallexample
7408 @noindent
7409 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7410 name normally:
7411
7412 @smallexample
7413 (gdb) overlay list
7414 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7415 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7416 (gdb) print foo
7417 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7418 @end smallexample
7419
7420 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7421 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7422 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7423 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7424 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7425
7426 @itemize @bullet
7427 @item
7428 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7429 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7430 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7431 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7432 @item
7433 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7434 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7435 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7436 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7437 breakpoints properly.
7438 @end itemize
7439
7440
7441 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7442 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7443 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
7444
7445 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7446 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7447 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7448 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7449 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7450 current state of the overlays.
7451
7452 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7453 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7454
7455 @table @asis
7456
7457 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
7458 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7459
7460 @smallexample
7461 struct
7462 @{
7463 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7464 unsigned long vma;
7465
7466 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7467 unsigned long size;
7468
7469 /* The overlay's load address. */
7470 unsigned long lma;
7471
7472 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7473 zero otherwise. */
7474 unsigned long mapped;
7475 @}
7476 @end smallexample
7477
7478 @item @code{_novlys}:
7479 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7480 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7481
7482 @end table
7483
7484 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7485 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7486 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7487 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7488 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7489 currently mapped.
7490
7491 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
7492 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
7493 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7494 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7495 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7496 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7497 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7498 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7499 are not being executed.
7500
7501 @node Overlay Sample Program
7502 @section Overlay Sample Program
7503 @cindex overlay example program
7504
7505 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7506 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7507 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7508 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7509 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7510 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7511 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7512
7513 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7514 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7515 suite. The program consists of the following files from
7516 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7517
7518 @table @file
7519 @item overlays.c
7520 The main program file.
7521 @item ovlymgr.c
7522 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7523 @item foo.c
7524 @itemx bar.c
7525 @itemx baz.c
7526 @itemx grbx.c
7527 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7528 @item d10v.ld
7529 @itemx m32r.ld
7530 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7531 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7532 @end table
7533
7534 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7535 cross-compiler like this:
7536
7537 @smallexample
7538 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7539 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7540 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7541 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7542 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7543 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7544 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7545 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
7546 @end smallexample
7547
7548 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7549 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7550 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7551
7552
7553 @node Languages
7554 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7555 @cindex languages
7556
7557 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7558 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7559 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7560 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
7561 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
7562 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
7563
7564 @cindex working language
7565 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7566 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7567 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7568 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7569 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7570 language}.
7571
7572 @menu
7573 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
7574 * Show:: Displaying the language
7575 * Checks:: Type and range checks
7576 * Support:: Supported languages
7577 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
7578 @end menu
7579
7580 @node Setting
7581 @section Switching between source languages
7582
7583 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7584 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7585 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7586 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7587 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7588 are printed, etc.
7589
7590 In addition to the working language, every source file that
7591 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7592 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7593 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7594 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
7595 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
7596 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
7597 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7598 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7599 Displaying the language}.
7600
7601 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
7602 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
7603 another language. In that case, make the
7604 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7605 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7606 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7607
7608 @menu
7609 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7610 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7611 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7612 @end menu
7613
7614 @node Filenames
7615 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7616
7617 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7618 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7619
7620 @table @file
7621
7622 @item .c
7623 C source file
7624
7625 @item .C
7626 @itemx .cc
7627 @itemx .cp
7628 @itemx .cpp
7629 @itemx .cxx
7630 @itemx .c++
7631 C@t{++} source file
7632
7633 @item .m
7634 Objective-C source file
7635
7636 @item .f
7637 @itemx .F
7638 Fortran source file
7639
7640 @item .mod
7641 Modula-2 source file
7642
7643 @item .s
7644 @itemx .S
7645 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7646 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7647 @end table
7648
7649 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7650 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7651
7652 @node Manually
7653 @subsection Setting the working language
7654
7655 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7656 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7657 your program.
7658
7659 @kindex set language
7660 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7661 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
7662 a language, such as
7663 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
7664 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7665
7666 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7667 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7668 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7669 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7670 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7671 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7672 command such as:
7673
7674 @smallexample
7675 print a = b + c
7676 @end smallexample
7677
7678 @noindent
7679 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7680 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7681 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7682 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
7683
7684 @node Automatically
7685 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7686
7687 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7688 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7689 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7690 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7691 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7692 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7693 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7694 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7695 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7696
7697 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7698 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7699 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7700 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7701 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7702
7703 @node Show
7704 @section Displaying the language
7705
7706 The following commands help you find out which language is the
7707 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7708
7709 @kindex show language
7710 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7711 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
7712 @table @code
7713 @item show language
7714 Display the current working language. This is the
7715 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7716 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7717
7718 @item info frame
7719 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
7720 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
7721 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
7722 information listed here.
7723
7724 @item info source
7725 Display the source language of this source file.
7726 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
7727 information listed here.
7728 @end table
7729
7730 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7731 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7732 with a language explicitly:
7733
7734 @kindex set extension-language
7735 @kindex info extensions
7736 @table @code
7737 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7738 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7739 the source language @var{language}.
7740
7741 @item info extensions
7742 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7743 @end table
7744
7745 @node Checks
7746 @section Type and range checking
7747
7748 @quotation
7749 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7750 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7751 section documents the intended facilities.
7752 @end quotation
7753 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7754
7755 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7756 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7757 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7758 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7759 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7760 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7761 errors when your program is running.
7762
7763 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7764 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7765 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7766 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7767 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7768 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7769 for the default settings of supported languages.
7770
7771 @menu
7772 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7773 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7774 @end menu
7775
7776 @cindex type checking
7777 @cindex checks, type
7778 @node Type Checking
7779 @subsection An overview of type checking
7780
7781 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7782 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7783 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7784 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7785
7786 @smallexample
7787 1 + 2 @result{} 3
7788 @exdent but
7789 @error{} 1 + 2.3
7790 @end smallexample
7791
7792 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7793 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7794
7795 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7796 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7797 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7798 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
7799 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7800 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7801 also issues a warning.
7802
7803 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7804 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7805 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7806 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7807 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
7808 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7809
7810 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7811 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7812 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7813 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7814 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7815 details on specific languages.
7816
7817 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7818
7819 @kindex set check@r{, type}
7820 @kindex set check type
7821 @kindex show check type
7822 @table @code
7823 @item set check type auto
7824 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7825 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7826 each language.
7827
7828 @item set check type on
7829 @itemx set check type off
7830 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7831 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7832 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
7833 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
7834 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7835
7836 @item set check type warn
7837 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7838 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7839 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7840 numbers and structures.
7841
7842 @item show type
7843 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7844 is setting it automatically.
7845 @end table
7846
7847 @cindex range checking
7848 @cindex checks, range
7849 @node Range Checking
7850 @subsection An overview of range checking
7851
7852 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7853 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7854 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7855 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7856 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7857
7858 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7859 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7860 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7861 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7862
7863 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7864 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7865 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7866 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7867 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7868 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7869
7870 @smallexample
7871 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7872 @end smallexample
7873
7874 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7875 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7876 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7877
7878 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7879
7880 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7881 @kindex set check range
7882 @kindex show check range
7883 @table @code
7884 @item set check range auto
7885 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7886 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7887 each language.
7888
7889 @item set check range on
7890 @itemx set check range off
7891 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7892 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7893 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7894 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7895
7896 @item set check range warn
7897 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7898 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7899 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7900 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7901 systems).
7902
7903 @item show range
7904 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7905 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7906 @end table
7907
7908 @node Support
7909 @section Supported languages
7910
7911 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
7912 @c This is false ...
7913 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7914 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7915 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7916 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7917 language.
7918
7919 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7920 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7921 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7922 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7923 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7924 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7925 language reference or tutorial.
7926
7927 @menu
7928 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7929 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
7930 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7931 @end menu
7932
7933 @node C
7934 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7935
7936 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7937 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7938
7939 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7940 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7941 together.
7942
7943 @cindex C@t{++}
7944 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7945 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7946 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7947 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7948 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7949 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7950 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7951
7952 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7953 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7954 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7955 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7956 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7957 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
7958
7959 @menu
7960 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7961 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7962 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7963 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7964 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7965 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7966 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7967 @end menu
7968
7969 @node C Operators
7970 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7971
7972 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7973
7974 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7975 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7976 often defined on groups of types.
7977
7978 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7979
7980 @itemize @bullet
7981
7982 @item
7983 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7984 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7985
7986 @item
7987 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7988 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7989
7990 @item
7991 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7992
7993 @item
7994 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7995
7996 @end itemize
7997
7998 @noindent
7999 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8000 in order of increasing precedence:
8001
8002 @table @code
8003 @item ,
8004 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8005 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8006 expression being the last expression evaluated.
8007
8008 @item =
8009 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8010 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8011
8012 @item @var{op}=
8013 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8014 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
8015 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
8016 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8017 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8018
8019 @item ?:
8020 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
8021 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
8022 integral type.
8023
8024 @item ||
8025 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8026
8027 @item &&
8028 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8029
8030 @item |
8031 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8032
8033 @item ^
8034 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8035
8036 @item &
8037 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8038
8039 @item ==@r{, }!=
8040 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
8041 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8042
8043 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8044 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8045 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8046 and non-zero for true.
8047
8048 @item <<@r{, }>>
8049 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8050
8051 @item @@
8052 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8053
8054 @item +@r{, }-
8055 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8056 pointer types.
8057
8058 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
8059 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
8060 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
8061 integral types.
8062
8063 @item ++@r{, }--
8064 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
8065 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
8066 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
8067 operation takes place.
8068
8069 @item *
8070 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
8071 @code{++}.
8072
8073 @item &
8074 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
8075
8076 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
8077 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
8078 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
8079 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
8080 stored.
8081
8082 @item -
8083 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
8084 precedence as @code{++}.
8085
8086 @item !
8087 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8088 @code{++}.
8089
8090 @item ~
8091 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8092 @code{++}.
8093
8094
8095 @item .@r{, }->
8096 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
8097 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
8098 pointer based on the stored type information.
8099 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
8100
8101 @item .*@r{, }->*
8102 Dereferences of pointers to members.
8103
8104 @item []
8105 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
8106 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8107
8108 @item ()
8109 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8110
8111 @item ::
8112 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
8113 and @code{class} types.
8114
8115 @item ::
8116 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8117 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8118 above.
8119 @end table
8120
8121 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8122 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8123 predefined meaning.
8124
8125 @menu
8126 * C Constants::
8127 @end menu
8128
8129 @node C Constants
8130 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
8131
8132 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8133
8134 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8135 following ways:
8136
8137 @itemize @bullet
8138 @item
8139 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8140 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8141 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8142 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8143 @code{long} value.
8144
8145 @item
8146 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8147 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8148 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8149 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8150 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8151 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8152 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8153 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8154 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8155 constant.
8156
8157 @item
8158 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8159 integral equivalents.
8160
8161 @item
8162 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8163 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8164 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8165 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8166 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8167 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8168 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8169 @samp{\n} for newline.
8170
8171 @item
8172 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8173 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8174 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8175 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8176 characters.
8177
8178 @item
8179 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8180 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8181
8182 @item
8183 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8184 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8185 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8186 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8187 @end itemize
8188
8189 @menu
8190 * C plus plus expressions::
8191 * C Defaults::
8192 * C Checks::
8193
8194 * Debugging C::
8195 @end menu
8196
8197 @node C plus plus expressions
8198 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8199
8200 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8201 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8202
8203 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8204 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
8205 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8206 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
8207 @quotation
8208 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8209 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8210 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8211 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8212 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8213 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8214 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8215 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8216 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8217 C@t{++} code.
8218 @end quotation
8219
8220 @enumerate
8221
8222 @cindex member functions
8223 @item
8224 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8225
8226 @smallexample
8227 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8228 @end smallexample
8229
8230 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8231 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8232 @item
8233 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8234 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8235 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8236 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8237
8238 @cindex call overloaded functions
8239 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8240 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8241 @item
8242 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8243 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8244 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8245 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8246 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8247 default arguments.
8248
8249 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8250 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8251 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8252 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8253 number of function arguments.
8254
8255 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8256 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8257 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8258
8259 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8260 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8261 @smallexample
8262 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8263 @end smallexample
8264
8265 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8266 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8267
8268 @cindex reference declarations
8269 @item
8270 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8271 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8272 dereferenced.
8273
8274 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8275 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8276 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8277 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8278 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8279
8280 @item
8281 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8282 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8283 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8284 necessary, for example in an expression like
8285 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8286 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8287 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8288 @end enumerate
8289
8290 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8291 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8292 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8293 invoking user-defined operators.
8294
8295 @node C Defaults
8296 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8297
8298 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8299
8300 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8301 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8302 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8303 selects the working language.
8304
8305 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8306 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8307 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8308 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8309 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8310 for further details.
8311
8312 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8313 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8314 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8315
8316 @node C Checks
8317 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8318
8319 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8320
8321 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8322 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8323 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8324
8325 @itemize @bullet
8326 @item
8327 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8328 enumerated tag.
8329
8330 @item
8331 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8332 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8333
8334 @ignore
8335 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8336 @c FIXME--beers?
8337 @item
8338 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8339 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8340 compilers.)
8341 @end ignore
8342 @end itemize
8343
8344 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8345 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8346 that is not itself an array.
8347
8348 @node Debugging C
8349 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8350
8351 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8352 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8353 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8354 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8355
8356 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8357 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8358 ,Expressions}.
8359
8360 @menu
8361 * Debugging C plus plus::
8362 @end menu
8363
8364 @node Debugging C plus plus
8365 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8366
8367 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8368
8369 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8370 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8371
8372 @table @code
8373 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8374 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8375 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8376 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8377 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8378
8379 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8380 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8381 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8382 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8383 classes.
8384 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8385
8386 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8387 @item catch throw
8388 @itemx catch catch
8389 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8390 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8391
8392 @cindex inheritance
8393 @item ptype @var{typename}
8394 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8395 @var{typename}.
8396 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8397
8398 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8399 @item set print demangle
8400 @itemx show print demangle
8401 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8402 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8403 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8404 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8405 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8406
8407 @item set print object
8408 @itemx show print object
8409 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8410 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8411
8412 @item set print vtbl
8413 @itemx show print vtbl
8414 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8415 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8416 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8417 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8418
8419 @kindex set overload-resolution
8420 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8421 @item set overload-resolution on
8422 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8423 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8424 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8425 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8426 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8427 message.
8428
8429 @item set overload-resolution off
8430 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
8431 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8432 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8433 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8434 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8435 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8436 argument types.
8437
8438 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8439 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
8440 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
8441 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8442 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8443 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8444 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8445 @end table
8446
8447 @node Objective-C
8448 @subsection Objective-C
8449
8450 @cindex Objective-C
8451 This section provides information about some commands and command
8452 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code.
8453
8454 @menu
8455 * Method Names in Commands::
8456 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
8457 @end menu
8458
8459 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
8460 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
8461
8462 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
8463 names as line specifications:
8464
8465 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
8466 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
8467 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
8468 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
8469 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
8470 @itemize
8471 @item @code{clear}
8472 @item @code{break}
8473 @item @code{info line}
8474 @item @code{jump}
8475 @item @code{list}
8476 @end itemize
8477
8478 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
8479
8480 @smallexample
8481 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
8482 @end smallexample
8483
8484 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
8485 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
8486 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
8487 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
8488 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
8489 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
8490 debugged, enter:
8491
8492 @smallexample
8493 break -[Fruit create]
8494 @end smallexample
8495
8496 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
8497 enter:
8498
8499 @smallexample
8500 list +[NSText initialize]
8501 @end smallexample
8502
8503 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
8504 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
8505 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
8506 is also possible to specify just a method name:
8507
8508 @smallexample
8509 break create
8510 @end smallexample
8511
8512 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
8513 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
8514 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
8515 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
8516 none apply.
8517
8518 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
8519 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
8520
8521 @smallexample
8522 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
8523 @end smallexample
8524
8525 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
8526 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
8527 @kindex print-object
8528 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
8529
8530 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
8531
8532 @smallexample
8533 print -[@var{object} hash]
8534 @end smallexample
8535
8536 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
8537 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
8538 @noindent
8539 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
8540 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
8541 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
8542 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
8543 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
8544 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
8545
8546 @node Modula-2, , Objective-C, Support
8547 @subsection Modula-2
8548
8549 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
8550
8551 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8552 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8553 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8554 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8555 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8556 table.
8557
8558 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
8559 @menu
8560 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8561 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8562 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8563 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8564 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8565 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8566 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8567 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8568 @end menu
8569
8570 @node M2 Operators
8571 @subsubsection Operators
8572 @cindex Modula-2 operators
8573
8574 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8575 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8576 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8577 following definitions hold:
8578
8579 @itemize @bullet
8580
8581 @item
8582 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8583 their subranges.
8584
8585 @item
8586 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8587
8588 @item
8589 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8590
8591 @item
8592 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8593 @var{type}}.
8594
8595 @item
8596 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8597
8598 @item
8599 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8600
8601 @item
8602 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8603 @end itemize
8604
8605 @noindent
8606 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8607 increasing precedence:
8608
8609 @table @code
8610 @item ,
8611 Function argument or array index separator.
8612
8613 @item :=
8614 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8615 @var{value}.
8616
8617 @item <@r{, }>
8618 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8619 types.
8620
8621 @item <=@r{, }>=
8622 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
8623 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8624 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8625
8626 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8627 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8628 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8629 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8630 comment character.
8631
8632 @item IN
8633 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8634 Same precedence as @code{<}.
8635
8636 @item OR
8637 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8638
8639 @item AND@r{, }&
8640 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8641
8642 @item @@
8643 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8644
8645 @item +@r{, }-
8646 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8647 and difference on set types.
8648
8649 @item *
8650 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8651 on set types.
8652
8653 @item /
8654 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8655 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8656
8657 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
8658 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8659 precedence as @code{*}.
8660
8661 @item -
8662 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8663
8664 @item ^
8665 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8666
8667 @item NOT
8668 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8669 @code{^}.
8670
8671 @item .
8672 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8673 precedence as @code{^}.
8674
8675 @item []
8676 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8677
8678 @item ()
8679 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8680 as @code{^}.
8681
8682 @item ::@r{, }.
8683 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8684 @end table
8685
8686 @quotation
8687 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8688 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8689 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8690 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8691 @end quotation
8692
8693
8694 @node Built-In Func/Proc
8695 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
8696 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
8697
8698 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8699 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8700
8701 @table @var
8702
8703 @item a
8704 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8705
8706 @item c
8707 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8708
8709 @item i
8710 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8711
8712 @item m
8713 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8714 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8715 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8716
8717 @item n
8718 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8719
8720 @item r
8721 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8722
8723 @item t
8724 represents a type.
8725
8726 @item v
8727 represents a variable.
8728
8729 @item x
8730 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8731 explanation of the function for details.
8732 @end table
8733
8734 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8735
8736 @table @code
8737 @item ABS(@var{n})
8738 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8739
8740 @item CAP(@var{c})
8741 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
8742 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
8743
8744 @item CHR(@var{i})
8745 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8746
8747 @item DEC(@var{v})
8748 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8749
8750 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8751 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8752 new value.
8753
8754 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8755 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8756 set.
8757
8758 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
8759 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8760
8761 @item HIGH(@var{a})
8762 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8763
8764 @item INC(@var{v})
8765 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8766
8767 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8768 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8769 new value.
8770
8771 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8772 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8773 there. Returns the new set.
8774
8775 @item MAX(@var{t})
8776 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8777
8778 @item MIN(@var{t})
8779 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8780
8781 @item ODD(@var{i})
8782 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8783
8784 @item ORD(@var{x})
8785 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
8786 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8787 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
8788 integral, character and enumerated types.
8789
8790 @item SIZE(@var{x})
8791 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8792
8793 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
8794 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8795
8796 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8797 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8798 @end table
8799
8800 @quotation
8801 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8802 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8803 an error.
8804 @end quotation
8805
8806 @cindex Modula-2 constants
8807 @node M2 Constants
8808 @subsubsection Constants
8809
8810 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8811 ways:
8812
8813 @itemize @bullet
8814
8815 @item
8816 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8817 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8818 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8819 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8820
8821 @item
8822 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8823 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8824 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8825 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8826 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8827 digits.
8828
8829 @item
8830 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8831 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
8832 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
8833 followed by a @samp{C}.
8834
8835 @item
8836 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8837 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8838 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
8839 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
8840 sequences.
8841
8842 @item
8843 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8844
8845 @item
8846 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8847 @code{FALSE}.
8848
8849 @item
8850 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8851
8852 @item
8853 Set constants are not yet supported.
8854 @end itemize
8855
8856 @node M2 Defaults
8857 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8858 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
8859
8860 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8861 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8862 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8863 selected the working language.
8864
8865 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8866 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
8867 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8868 the language automatically}, for further details.
8869
8870 @node Deviations
8871 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8872 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8873
8874 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8875 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8876
8877 @itemize @bullet
8878 @item
8879 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8880 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8881 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8882 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8883 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8884 returned a pointer.)
8885
8886 @item
8887 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8888 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8889 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8890 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8891
8892 @item
8893 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8894 argument.
8895
8896 @item
8897 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8898 @end itemize
8899
8900 @node M2 Checks
8901 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8902 @cindex Modula-2 checks
8903
8904 @quotation
8905 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8906 range checking.
8907 @end quotation
8908 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8909
8910 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8911
8912 @itemize @bullet
8913 @item
8914 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8915 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8916
8917 @item
8918 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8919 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8920 @end itemize
8921
8922 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8923 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8924
8925 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8926 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8927
8928 @node M2 Scope
8929 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8930 @cindex scope
8931 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8932 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8933 @ifinfo
8934 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8935 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8936 @end ifinfo
8937 @iftex
8938 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8939 @end iftex
8940
8941 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8942 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8943 similar syntax:
8944
8945 @smallexample
8946
8947 @var{module} . @var{id}
8948 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8949 @end smallexample
8950
8951 @noindent
8952 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8953 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8954 identifier within your program, except another module.
8955
8956 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8957 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8958 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8959 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8960
8961 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8962 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8963 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8964 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8965 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8966 @var{module}.
8967
8968 @node GDB/M2
8969 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8970
8971 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8972 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8973 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8974 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8975 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8976 analogue in Modula-2.
8977
8978 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8979 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8980 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8981 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8982 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8983 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8984
8985 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8986 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8987 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8988
8989 @node Unsupported languages
8990 @section Unsupported languages
8991
8992 @cindex unsupported languages
8993 @cindex minimal language
8994 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
8995 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
8996 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
8997 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
8998 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
8999 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
9000
9001 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
9002 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
9003 language.
9004
9005 @node Symbols
9006 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
9007
9008 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
9009 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
9010 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
9011 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
9012 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
9013 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
9014 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9015
9016 @cindex symbol names
9017 @cindex names of symbols
9018 @cindex quoting names
9019 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
9020 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
9021 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
9022 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
9023 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
9024 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
9025 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
9026 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
9027
9028 @smallexample
9029 p 'foo.c'::x
9030 @end smallexample
9031
9032 @noindent
9033 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
9034
9035 @table @code
9036 @kindex info address
9037 @cindex address of a symbol
9038 @item info address @var{symbol}
9039 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
9040 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
9041 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
9042 is always stored.
9043
9044 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
9045 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
9046 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
9047
9048 @kindex info symbol
9049 @cindex symbol from address
9050 @item info symbol @var{addr}
9051 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
9052 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
9053 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
9054
9055 @smallexample
9056 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
9057 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
9058 @end smallexample
9059
9060 @noindent
9061 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
9062 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
9063
9064 @kindex whatis
9065 @item whatis @var{expr}
9066 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
9067 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
9068 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
9069 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9070
9071 @item whatis
9072 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9073
9074 @kindex ptype
9075 @item ptype @var{typename}
9076 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
9077 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
9078 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
9079 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
9080
9081 @item ptype @var{expr}
9082 @itemx ptype
9083 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
9084 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
9085 of just the name of the type.
9086
9087 For example, for this variable declaration:
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
9091 @end smallexample
9092
9093 @noindent
9094 the two commands give this output:
9095
9096 @smallexample
9097 @group
9098 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
9099 type = struct complex
9100 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
9101 type = struct complex @{
9102 double real;
9103 double imag;
9104 @}
9105 @end group
9106 @end smallexample
9107
9108 @noindent
9109 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
9110 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9111
9112 @kindex info types
9113 @item info types @var{regexp}
9114 @itemx info types
9115 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
9116 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
9117 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
9118 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
9119 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
9120 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
9121
9122 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
9123 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9124 lists all source files where a type is defined.
9125
9126 @kindex info scope
9127 @cindex local variables
9128 @item info scope @var{addr}
9129 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9130 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9131 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9132 scope defined by that location. For example:
9133
9134 @smallexample
9135 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9136 Scope for command_line_handler:
9137 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9138 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9139 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9140 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9141 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9142 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9143 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9144 @end smallexample
9145
9146 @noindent
9147 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9148 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9149 collect}.
9150
9151 @kindex info source
9152 @item info source
9153 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9154 the function containing the current point of execution:
9155 @itemize @bullet
9156 @item
9157 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9158 @item
9159 the directory it was compiled in,
9160 @item
9161 its length, in lines,
9162 @item
9163 which programming language it is written in,
9164 @item
9165 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9166 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9167 @item
9168 whether the debugging information includes information about
9169 preprocessor macros.
9170 @end itemize
9171
9172
9173 @kindex info sources
9174 @item info sources
9175 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9176 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9177 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9178
9179 @kindex info functions
9180 @item info functions
9181 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9182
9183 @item info functions @var{regexp}
9184 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9185 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9186 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9187 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
9188 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9189 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
9190 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
9191
9192 @kindex info variables
9193 @item info variables
9194 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
9195 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
9196
9197 @item info variables @var{regexp}
9198 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9199 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9200 @var{regexp}.
9201
9202 @kindex info classes
9203 @item info classes
9204 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
9205 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
9206 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9207 expression.
9208
9209 @kindex info selectors
9210 @item info selectors
9211 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
9212 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
9213 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9214 expression.
9215
9216 @ignore
9217 This was never implemented.
9218 @kindex info methods
9219 @item info methods
9220 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9221 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
9222 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9223 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9224 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
9225 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9226 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9227 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9228 @end ignore
9229
9230 @cindex reloading symbols
9231 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
9232 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9233 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9234 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9235 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
9236
9237 @table @code
9238 @kindex set symbol-reloading
9239 @item set symbol-reloading on
9240 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9241 object file with a particular name is seen again.
9242
9243 @item set symbol-reloading off
9244 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9245 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9246 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9247 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9248 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9249 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9250 name.
9251
9252 @kindex show symbol-reloading
9253 @item show symbol-reloading
9254 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9255 @end table
9256
9257 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9258 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
9259 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9260 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9261 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9262 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9263 another source file. The default is on.
9264
9265 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9266 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9267
9268 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
9269 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9270 is printed as follows:
9271 @smallexample
9272 @{<no data fields>@}
9273 @end smallexample
9274
9275 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9276 @item show opaque-type-resolution
9277 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
9278
9279 @kindex maint print symbols
9280 @cindex symbol dump
9281 @kindex maint print psymbols
9282 @cindex partial symbol dump
9283 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9284 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9285 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9286 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9287 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9288 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9289 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9290 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9291 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9292 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9293 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9294 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9295 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9296 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9297 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9298 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9299 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9300
9301 @kindex maint info symtabs
9302 @kindex maint info psymtabs
9303 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
9304 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9305 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9306 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9307 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9308 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9309
9310 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
9311 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
9312 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
9313 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
9314 structure in more detail. For example:
9315
9316 @smallexample
9317 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
9318 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9319 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9320 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9321 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
9322 readin no
9323 fullname (null)
9324 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
9325 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
9326 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
9327 dependencies (none)
9328 @}
9329 @}
9330 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
9331 (@value{GDBP})
9332 @end smallexample
9333 @noindent
9334 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
9335 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
9336 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
9337 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
9338 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
9339
9340 @smallexample
9341 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
9342 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
9343 line 1574.
9344 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
9345 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9346 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9347 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9348 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
9349 dirname (null)
9350 fullname (null)
9351 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
9352 debugformat DWARF 2
9353 @}
9354 @}
9355 (@value{GDBP})
9356 @end smallexample
9357 @end table
9358
9359
9360 @node Altering
9361 @chapter Altering Execution
9362
9363 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9364 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9365 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9366 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9367 program.
9368
9369 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
9370 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9371 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
9372
9373 @menu
9374 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9375 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
9376 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
9377 * Returning:: Returning from a function
9378 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9379 * Patching:: Patching your program
9380 @end menu
9381
9382 @node Assignment
9383 @section Assignment to variables
9384
9385 @cindex assignment
9386 @cindex setting variables
9387 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9388 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9389
9390 @smallexample
9391 print x=4
9392 @end smallexample
9393
9394 @noindent
9395 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
9396 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
9397 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9398 information on operators in supported languages.
9399
9400 @kindex set variable
9401 @cindex variables, setting
9402 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9403 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9404 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9405 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9406 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9407
9408 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9409 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9410 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9411 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9412 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9413 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9414 command @code{set width}:
9415
9416 @smallexample
9417 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9418 type = double
9419 (@value{GDBP}) p width
9420 $4 = 13
9421 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9422 Invalid syntax in expression.
9423 @end smallexample
9424
9425 @noindent
9426 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9427 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9428
9429 @smallexample
9430 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
9431 @end smallexample
9432
9433 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9434 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9435 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9436 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9437 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9438 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9439
9440 @smallexample
9441 @group
9442 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9443 type = double
9444 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9445 $1 = 1
9446 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
9447 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9448 $2 = 1
9449 (@value{GDBP}) r
9450 The program being debugged has been started already.
9451 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9452 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
9453 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9454 Invalid bfd target.
9455 (@value{GDBP}) show g
9456 The current BFD target is "=4".
9457 @end group
9458 @end smallexample
9459
9460 @noindent
9461 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9462 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9463 @code{g}, use
9464
9465 @smallexample
9466 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
9467 @end smallexample
9468
9469 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9470 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9471 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9472 same length or shorter.
9473 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9474 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9475
9476 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9477 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9478 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9479 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9480 and representation in memory), and
9481
9482 @smallexample
9483 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9484 @end smallexample
9485
9486 @noindent
9487 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9488
9489 @node Jumping
9490 @section Continuing at a different address
9491
9492 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9493 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9494 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9495
9496 @table @code
9497 @kindex jump
9498 @item jump @var{linespec}
9499 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9500 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9501 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9502 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9503 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9504 breakpoints}.
9505
9506 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9507 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9508 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9509 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9510 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9511 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9512 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9513 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9514 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9515
9516 @item jump *@var{address}
9517 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9518 @end table
9519
9520 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
9521 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9522 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9523 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9524 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9525 example,
9526
9527 @smallexample
9528 set $pc = 0x485
9529 @end smallexample
9530
9531 @noindent
9532 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9533 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9534 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9535
9536 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9537 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9538 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9539 detail.
9540
9541 @c @group
9542 @node Signaling
9543 @section Giving your program a signal
9544
9545 @table @code
9546 @kindex signal
9547 @item signal @var{signal}
9548 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9549 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9550 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9551 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9552
9553 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9554 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9555 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9556 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9557 signal.
9558
9559 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9560 after executing the command.
9561 @end table
9562 @c @end group
9563
9564 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9565 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9566 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9567 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9568 passes the signal directly to your program.
9569
9570
9571 @node Returning
9572 @section Returning from a function
9573
9574 @table @code
9575 @cindex returning from a function
9576 @kindex return
9577 @item return
9578 @itemx return @var{expression}
9579 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9580 command. If you give an
9581 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9582 value.
9583 @end table
9584
9585 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9586 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9587 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9588 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9589
9590 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9591 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9592 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9593 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9594 of functions.
9595
9596 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9597 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9598 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9599 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9600 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9601
9602 @node Calling
9603 @section Calling program functions
9604
9605 @cindex calling functions
9606 @kindex call
9607 @table @code
9608 @item call @var{expr}
9609 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9610 returned values.
9611 @end table
9612
9613 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9614 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9615 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9616 is printed and saved in the value history.
9617
9618 @node Patching
9619 @section Patching programs
9620
9621 @cindex patching binaries
9622 @cindex writing into executables
9623 @cindex writing into corefiles
9624
9625 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9626 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9627 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9628 patching your program's binary.
9629
9630 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9631 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9632 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9633 repairs.
9634
9635 @table @code
9636 @kindex set write
9637 @item set write on
9638 @itemx set write off
9639 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9640 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9641 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9642
9643 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9644 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9645 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9646
9647 @item show write
9648 @kindex show write
9649 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9650 as well as reading.
9651 @end table
9652
9653 @node GDB Files
9654 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9655
9656 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9657 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9658 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9659 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9660
9661 @menu
9662 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9663 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
9664 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9665 @end menu
9666
9667 @node Files
9668 @section Commands to specify files
9669
9670 @cindex symbol table
9671 @cindex core dump file
9672
9673 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9674 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9675 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9676 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9677
9678 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9679 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9680 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9681 to specify new files are useful.
9682
9683 @table @code
9684 @cindex executable file
9685 @kindex file
9686 @item file @var{filename}
9687 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9688 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9689 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9690 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9691 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9692 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9693 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9694 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9695
9696 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9697 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9698 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9699 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9700 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9701 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9702 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9703 for more information.
9704
9705 @item file
9706 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9707 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9708
9709 @kindex exec-file
9710 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9711 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9712 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9713 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9714 discard information on the executable file.
9715
9716 @kindex symbol-file
9717 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9718 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9719 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9720 table and program to run from the same file.
9721
9722 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9723 program's symbol table.
9724
9725 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9726 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9727 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9728 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9729 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9730
9731 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9732 executing it once.
9733
9734 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9735 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9736 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9737 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9738 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9739 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9740 optimized code.
9741
9742 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9743 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9744 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9745 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9746 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9747
9748 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9749 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9750 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9751 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9752 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9753 warnings and messages}.)
9754
9755 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9756 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9757 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9758 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9759 in stabs format.
9760
9761 @kindex readnow
9762 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9763 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9764 @kindex mapped
9765 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9766 @cindex saving symbol table
9767 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9768 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9769 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9770 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9771 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9772 entire symbol table available.
9773
9774 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9775 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9776 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9777 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9778 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9779 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9780 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9781 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9782
9783 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9784 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9785
9786 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9787 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9788 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9789 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9790 needed.
9791
9792 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9793 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9794 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9795
9796 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9797 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9798 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9799 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9800 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9801 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9802 @c files.
9803
9804 @kindex core
9805 @kindex core-file
9806 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9807 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9808 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9809 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9810 executable file itself for other parts.
9811
9812 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9813 to be used.
9814
9815 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9816 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9817 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9818 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9819 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9820
9821 @kindex add-symbol-file
9822 @cindex dynamic linking
9823 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9824 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9825 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9826 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9827 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9828 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9829 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9830 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9831 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9832 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9833 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9834 @var{address} as an expression.
9835
9836 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9837 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9838 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9839 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9840 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9841
9842 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9843 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9844 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9845 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9846 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9847 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9848 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9849 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9850 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9851
9852 @itemize @bullet
9853 @item
9854 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9855 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9856 @item
9857 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9858 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9859 @item
9860 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9861 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9862 @end itemize
9863
9864 @noindent
9865 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9866 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9867 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9868 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9869 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9870 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9871 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9872 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9873 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9874 way.
9875
9876 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9877
9878 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9879 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9880 table information for @var{filename}.
9881
9882 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9883 @item add-shared-symbol-file
9884 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
9885 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9886 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
9887 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
9888
9889 @kindex section
9890 @item section
9891 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9892 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9893 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9894 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
9895 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9896 the sections and their addresses.
9897
9898 @kindex info files
9899 @kindex info target
9900 @item info files
9901 @itemx info target
9902 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9903 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9904 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9905 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9906 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9907 current ones.
9908
9909 @kindex maint info sections
9910 @item maint info sections
9911 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9912 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9913 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9914 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9915 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9916 may be arbitrarily combined):
9917
9918 @table @code
9919 @item ALLOBJ
9920 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9921 @item @var{sections}
9922 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
9923 @item @var{section-flags}
9924 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9925 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9926 @table @code
9927 @item ALLOC
9928 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9929 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9930 @item LOAD
9931 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9932 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9933 @item RELOC
9934 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9935 @item READONLY
9936 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9937 @item CODE
9938 Section contains executable code only.
9939 @item DATA
9940 Section contains data only (no executable code).
9941 @item ROM
9942 Section will reside in ROM.
9943 @item CONSTRUCTOR
9944 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9945 @item HAS_CONTENTS
9946 Section is not empty.
9947 @item NEVER_LOAD
9948 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9949 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9950 A notification to the linker that the section contains
9951 COFF shared library information.
9952 @item IS_COMMON
9953 Section contains common symbols.
9954 @end table
9955 @end table
9956 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9957 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
9958 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9959 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
9960 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9961 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9962 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9963 enhancement to debugging performance.
9964
9965 The default is off.
9966
9967 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
9968 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9969 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9970 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
9971 @end table
9972
9973 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9974 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9975 name and remembers it that way.
9976
9977 @cindex shared libraries
9978 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9979 libraries.
9980
9981 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9982 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9983 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9984 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9985 debugging a core file).
9986
9987 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9988 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9989
9990 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9991 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9992 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9993
9994 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9995 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9996 particularly large or there are many of them.
9997
9998 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9999 commands:
10000
10001 @table @code
10002 @kindex set auto-solib-add
10003 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
10004 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
10005 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
10006 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
10007 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
10008 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
10009 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
10010
10011 @kindex show auto-solib-add
10012 @item show auto-solib-add
10013 Display the current autoloading mode.
10014 @end table
10015
10016 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
10017 command:
10018
10019 @table @code
10020 @kindex info sharedlibrary
10021 @kindex info share
10022 @item info share
10023 @itemx info sharedlibrary
10024 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
10025
10026 @kindex sharedlibrary
10027 @kindex share
10028 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
10029 @itemx share @var{regex}
10030 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
10031 Unix regular expression.
10032 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
10033 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
10034 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
10035 loaded.
10036 @end table
10037
10038 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
10039 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
10040 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
10041 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
10042 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
10043 wish.
10044
10045 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
10046 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
10047 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
10048 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
10049
10050 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
10051
10052 @table @code
10053 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
10054 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
10055 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
10056 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
10057 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
10058 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
10059 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
10060 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
10061 Mb).
10062
10063 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
10064 @item show auto-solib-limit
10065 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
10066 @end table
10067
10068 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
10069 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
10070 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
10071 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
10072 not.
10073
10074 You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
10075 load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
10076 @value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
10077 libraries.
10078
10079 @table @code
10080 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
10081 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
10082 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
10083 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
10084 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
10085 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
10086 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
10087 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
10088
10089 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
10090 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
10091
10092 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
10093 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
10094 Display the current shared library prefix.
10095
10096 @kindex set solib-search-path
10097 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
10098 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
10099 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
10100 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
10101 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
10102 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
10103 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
10104 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
10105
10106 @kindex show solib-search-path
10107 @item show solib-search-path
10108 Display the current shared library search path.
10109 @end table
10110
10111
10112 @node Separate Debug Files
10113 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
10114 @cindex separate debugging information files
10115 @cindex debugging information in separate files
10116 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
10117 @cindex debugging information directory, global
10118 @cindex global debugging information directory
10119
10120 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
10121 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
10122 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
10123 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
10124 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
10125 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
10126 install only when they need to debug a problem.
10127
10128 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
10129 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
10130 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
10131 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
10132 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
10133 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
10134 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
10135 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
10136 places:
10137
10138 @itemize @bullet
10139 @item
10140 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
10141 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
10142 @item
10143 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
10144 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
10145 @item
10146 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
10147 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
10148 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
10149 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
10150 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
10151 @end itemize
10152 @noindent
10153 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
10154 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
10155 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
10156
10157 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
10158 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
10159 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
10160 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
10161 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
10162 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
10163
10164 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
10165 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
10166
10167 @table @code
10168
10169 @kindex set debug-file-directory
10170 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
10171 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10172 information files to @var{directory}.
10173
10174 @kindex show debug-file-directory
10175 @item show debug-file-directory
10176 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10177 information files.
10178
10179 @end table
10180
10181 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
10182 @cindex debug links
10183 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
10184 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
10185
10186 @itemize
10187 @item
10188 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
10189 a zero byte,
10190 @item
10191 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
10192 boundary within the section, and
10193 @item
10194 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
10195 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
10196 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
10197 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
10198 @end itemize
10199
10200 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
10201 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
10202 described above.
10203
10204 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
10205 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
10206 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
10207 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
10208 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
10209 in an ordinary executable.
10210
10211 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
10212 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
10213 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
10214 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
10215 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
10216 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
10217 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
10218
10219 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
10220 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
10221 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
10222 complete code for a function that computes it:
10223
10224 @kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
10225 @smallexample
10226 unsigned long
10227 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
10228 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
10229 @{
10230 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
10231 @{
10232 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
10233 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
10234 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
10235 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
10236 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
10237 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
10238 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
10239 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
10240 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
10241 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
10242 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
10243 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
10244 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
10245 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
10246 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
10247 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
10248 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
10249 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
10250 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
10251 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
10252 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
10253 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
10254 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
10255 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
10256 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
10257 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
10258 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
10259 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
10260 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
10261 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
10262 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
10263 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
10264 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
10265 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
10266 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
10267 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
10268 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
10269 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
10270 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
10271 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
10272 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
10273 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
10274 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
10275 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
10276 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
10277 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
10278 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
10279 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
10280 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
10281 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
10282 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
10283 0x2d02ef8d
10284 @};
10285 unsigned char *end;
10286
10287 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10288 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
10289 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
10290 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10291 @}
10292 @end smallexample
10293
10294
10295 @node Symbol Errors
10296 @section Errors reading symbol files
10297
10298 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
10299 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
10300 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
10301 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
10302 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
10303 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
10304 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
10305 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
10306 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
10307 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10308 messages}).
10309
10310 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
10311
10312 @table @code
10313 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
10314
10315 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
10316 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
10317 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
10318 in its outer scope blocks.
10319
10320 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10321 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10322 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10323 function.
10324
10325 @item block at @var{address} out of order
10326
10327 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10328 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10329 do so.
10330
10331 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10332 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10333 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10334 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10335 messages}.)
10336
10337 @item bad block start address patched
10338
10339 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10340 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10341 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10342
10343 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10344 starting on the previous source line.
10345
10346 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10347
10348 @cindex foo
10349 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10350 larger than the size of the string table.
10351
10352 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10353 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10354 with this name.
10355
10356 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10357
10358 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10359 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
10360 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
10361
10362 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10363 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
10364 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
10365 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10366 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10367 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
10368
10369 @item stub type has NULL name
10370
10371 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
10372
10373 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
10374 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
10375 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10376 it.
10377
10378 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10379
10380 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
10381
10382 @end table
10383
10384 @node Targets
10385 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
10386
10387 @cindex debugging target
10388 @kindex target
10389
10390 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
10391
10392 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10393 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10394 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
10395 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10396 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
10397 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10398 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10399 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10400
10401 @menu
10402 * Active Targets:: Active targets
10403 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
10404 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10405 * Remote:: Remote debugging
10406 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
10407
10408 @end menu
10409
10410 @node Active Targets
10411 @section Active targets
10412
10413 @cindex stacking targets
10414 @cindex active targets
10415 @cindex multiple targets
10416
10417 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
10418 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10419 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10420 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10421 a core file.
10422
10423 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10424 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10425 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10426 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10427 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10428 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10429 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10430 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10431 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
10432
10433 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
10434 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10435 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10436 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10437 process target is active.
10438
10439 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10440 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
10441 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
10442 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10443 process}).
10444
10445 @node Target Commands
10446 @section Commands for managing targets
10447
10448 @table @code
10449 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
10450 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10451 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10452 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10453 protocol of the target machine.
10454
10455 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10456 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10457 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
10458
10459 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10460 after executing the command.
10461
10462 @kindex help target
10463 @item help target
10464 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10465 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10466 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10467
10468 @item help target @var{name}
10469 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10470 select it.
10471
10472 @kindex set gnutarget
10473 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
10474 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
10475 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
10476 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10477 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
10478 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10479
10480 @quotation
10481 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10482 you must know the actual BFD name.
10483 @end quotation
10484
10485 @noindent
10486 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
10487
10488 @kindex show gnutarget
10489 @item show gnutarget
10490 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10491 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10492 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10493 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10494 @end table
10495
10496 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10497 configuration):
10498
10499 @table @code
10500 @kindex target exec
10501 @item target exec @var{program}
10502 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10503 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10504
10505 @kindex target core
10506 @item target core @var{filename}
10507 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10508 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
10509
10510 @kindex target remote
10511 @item target remote @var{dev}
10512 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10513 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10514 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
10515 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
10516 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10517 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10518
10519 @kindex target sim
10520 @item target sim
10521 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
10522 In general,
10523 @smallexample
10524 target sim
10525 load
10526 run
10527 @end smallexample
10528 @noindent
10529 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
10530 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
10531 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10532 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10533 Processors}.
10534
10535 @end table
10536
10537 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
10538
10539 @table @code
10540
10541 @kindex target nrom
10542 @item target nrom @var{dev}
10543 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10544
10545 @end table
10546
10547 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
10548 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
10549
10550 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10551 once you've successfully established a connection.
10552
10553 @table @code
10554
10555 @kindex load @var{filename}
10556 @item load @var{filename}
10557 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10558 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10559 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10560 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10561 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10562 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10563
10564 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10565 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10566 target is @dots{}}''
10567
10568 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10569 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10570 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10571 specifies a fixed address.
10572 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10573
10574 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10575 @end table
10576
10577 @node Byte Order
10578 @section Choosing target byte order
10579
10580 @cindex choosing target byte order
10581 @cindex target byte order
10582
10583 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
10584 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10585 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10586 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10587 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
10588 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
10589
10590 @table @code
10591 @kindex set endian big
10592 @item set endian big
10593 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10594
10595 @kindex set endian little
10596 @item set endian little
10597 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10598
10599 @kindex set endian auto
10600 @item set endian auto
10601 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10602 executable.
10603
10604 @item show endian
10605 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10606
10607 @end table
10608
10609 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10610 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10611 target system.
10612
10613 @node Remote
10614 @section Remote debugging
10615 @cindex remote debugging
10616
10617 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
10618 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10619 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
10620 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10621 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10622
10623 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10624 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
10625 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
10626 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10627 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10628 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10629
10630 Other remote targets may be available in your
10631 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
10632
10633 @node KOD
10634 @section Kernel Object Display
10635 @cindex kernel object display
10636 @cindex KOD
10637
10638 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10639 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10640 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10641 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10642 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10643
10644 @kindex set os
10645 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10646 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10647
10648 @smallexample
10649 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10650 @end smallexample
10651
10652 @kindex show os
10653 The associated command @code{show os} displays the operating system
10654 set with the @code{set os} command; if no operating system has been
10655 set, @code{show os} will display an empty string @samp{""}.
10656
10657 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10658 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10659 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10660 after the operating system:
10661
10662 @kindex info cisco
10663 @smallexample
10664 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10665 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10666 Object Description
10667 any Any and all objects
10668 @end smallexample
10669
10670 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10671 by the kernel.
10672
10673 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating
10674 system is supported other than to try setting it with @kbd{set os
10675 @var{name}}, where @var{name} is the name of the operating system you
10676 want to try.
10677
10678
10679 @node Remote Debugging
10680 @chapter Debugging remote programs
10681
10682 @menu
10683 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
10684 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10685 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10686 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
10687 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
10688 @end menu
10689
10690 @node Connecting
10691 @section Connecting to a remote target
10692
10693 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
10694 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
10695 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
10696 program as the first argument.
10697
10698 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10699 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
10700 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
10701 before the @code{target} command.
10702
10703 After that, use @code{target remote} to establish communications with
10704 the target machine. Its argument specifies how to communicate---either
10705 via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a TCP or UDP port
10706 (possibly to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
10707 target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the device
10708 named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10709
10710 @smallexample
10711 target remote /dev/ttyb
10712 @end smallexample
10713
10714 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10715 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10716 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10717 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10718 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10719
10720 @smallexample
10721 target remote manyfarms:2828
10722 @end smallexample
10723
10724 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10725 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10726 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10727 to port 1234 on your local machine:
10728
10729 @smallexample
10730 target remote :1234
10731 @end smallexample
10732 @noindent
10733
10734 Note that the colon is still required here.
10735
10736 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10737 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10738 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10739 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10740
10741 @smallexample
10742 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10743 @end smallexample
10744
10745 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10746 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10747 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10748 session.
10749
10750 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10751 step and continue the remote program.
10752
10753 @cindex interrupting remote programs
10754 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
10755 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10756 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10757 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10758 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10759 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10760
10761 @smallexample
10762 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10763 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10764 @end smallexample
10765
10766 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10767 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10768 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10769 goes back to waiting.
10770
10771 @table @code
10772 @kindex detach (remote)
10773 @item detach
10774 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
10775 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
10776 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
10777 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
10778 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
10779
10780 @kindex disconnect
10781 @item disconnect
10782 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
10783 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
10784 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
10785 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
10786 another target.
10787 @end table
10788
10789 @node Server
10790 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10791
10792 @kindex gdbserver
10793 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10794 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10795 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10796 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10797
10798 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10799 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10800 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10801 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10802 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10803 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10804 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10805 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10806 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10807 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10808 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10809 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10810 choice for debugging.
10811
10812 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10813 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10814 protocol.
10815
10816 @table @emph
10817 @item On the target machine,
10818 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10819 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10820 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10821 system does all the symbol handling.
10822
10823 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10824 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
10825 syntax is:
10826
10827 @smallexample
10828 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10829 @end smallexample
10830
10831 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10832 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10833 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10834 @file{/dev/com1}:
10835
10836 @smallexample
10837 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10838 @end smallexample
10839
10840 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10841 with it.
10842
10843 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10844
10845 @smallexample
10846 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10847 @end smallexample
10848
10849 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10850 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10851 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10852 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10853 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10854 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10855 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10856 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10857 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10858 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10859 @code{target remote} command.
10860
10861 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10862 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10863
10864 @smallexample
10865 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10866 @end smallexample
10867
10868 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10869 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10870
10871 @pindex pidof
10872 @cindex attach to a program by name
10873 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
10874 @code{pidof} utility:
10875
10876 @smallexample
10877 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
10878 @end smallexample
10879
10880 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
10881 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
10882 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
10883
10884 @item On the host machine,
10885 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
10886 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10887 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10888 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10889 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
10890 command in @value{GDBN} when using gdbserver, since the program is
10891 already on the target.
10892
10893 @end table
10894
10895 @node NetWare
10896 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10897
10898 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10899 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10900 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10901 @code{target remote}.
10902
10903 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10904 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10905
10906 @table @emph
10907 @item On the target machine,
10908 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10909 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10910 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10911 host system does all the symbol handling.
10912
10913 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10914 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10915 program. The syntax is:
10916
10917 @smallexample
10918 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10919 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10920 @end smallexample
10921
10922 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10923 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10924 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10925
10926 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10927 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10928 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10932 @end smallexample
10933
10934 @item
10935 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,
10936 Connecting to a remote target}).
10937
10938 @end table
10939
10940 @node Remote configuration
10941 @section Remote configuration
10942
10943 The following configuration options are available when debugging remote
10944 programs:
10945
10946 @table @code
10947 @kindex set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
10948 @kindex set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
10949 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
10950 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
10951 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
10952 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
10953 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
10954 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
10955 @end table
10956
10957 @node remote stub
10958 @section Implementing a remote stub
10959
10960 @cindex debugging stub, example
10961 @cindex remote stub, example
10962 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10963 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10964 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10965 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10966 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10967 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10968 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10969 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10970
10971 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10972 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10973 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10974 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10975 program, you need:
10976
10977 @enumerate
10978 @item
10979 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10980 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10981 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10982
10983 @item
10984 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10985 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10986
10987 @item
10988 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10989 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10990 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10991 documentation.
10992 @end enumerate
10993
10994 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10995 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10996 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10997
10998 @table @emph
10999 @item On the host,
11000 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
11001 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
11002 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
11003
11004 @item On the target,
11005 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
11006 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
11007 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
11008
11009 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
11010 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
11011 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
11012 @end table
11013
11014 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
11015 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
11016 @sc{sparc} boards.
11017
11018 @cindex remote serial stub list
11019 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
11020
11021 @table @code
11022
11023 @item i386-stub.c
11024 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
11025 @cindex Intel
11026 @cindex i386
11027 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
11028
11029 @item m68k-stub.c
11030 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
11031 @cindex Motorola 680x0
11032 @cindex m680x0
11033 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
11034
11035 @item sh-stub.c
11036 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
11037 @cindex Renesas
11038 @cindex SH
11039 For Renesas SH architectures.
11040
11041 @item sparc-stub.c
11042 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
11043 @cindex Sparc
11044 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
11045
11046 @item sparcl-stub.c
11047 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
11048 @cindex Fujitsu
11049 @cindex SparcLite
11050 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
11051
11052 @end table
11053
11054 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
11055 recently added stubs.
11056
11057 @menu
11058 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
11059 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
11060 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
11061 @end menu
11062
11063 @node Stub Contents
11064 @subsection What the stub can do for you
11065
11066 @cindex remote serial stub
11067 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
11068 subroutines:
11069
11070 @table @code
11071 @item set_debug_traps
11072 @kindex set_debug_traps
11073 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
11074 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
11075 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
11076 beginning of your program.
11077
11078 @item handle_exception
11079 @kindex handle_exception
11080 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
11081 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
11082 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
11083 run when a trap is triggered.
11084
11085 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
11086 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
11087 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
11088 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
11089 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
11090 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
11091 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
11092 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
11093 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
11094 machine.
11095
11096 @item breakpoint
11097 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
11098 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
11099 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
11100 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
11101 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
11102 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
11103 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
11104 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
11105 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
11106 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
11107 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
11108
11109 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
11110 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
11111 start of your debugging session.
11112 @end table
11113
11114 @node Bootstrapping
11115 @subsection What you must do for the stub
11116
11117 @cindex remote stub, support routines
11118 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
11119 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
11120 debugging target machine.
11121
11122 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
11123 serial port.
11124
11125 @table @code
11126 @item int getDebugChar()
11127 @kindex getDebugChar
11128 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
11129 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
11130 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11131
11132 @item void putDebugChar(int)
11133 @kindex putDebugChar
11134 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
11135 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
11136 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11137 @end table
11138
11139 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
11140 @cindex interrupting remote targets
11141 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
11142 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
11143 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
11144 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
11145 remote system to stop.
11146
11147 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
11148 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
11149 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
11150 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
11151
11152 Other routines you need to supply are:
11153
11154 @table @code
11155 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
11156 @kindex exceptionHandler
11157 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
11158 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
11159 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
11160 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
11161 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
11162 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
11163 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
11164 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
11165 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
11166 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
11167 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
11168 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
11169 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
11170
11171 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
11172 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
11173 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
11174 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
11175 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
11176
11177 @item void flush_i_cache()
11178 @kindex flush_i_cache
11179 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
11180 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
11181 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
11182
11183 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
11184 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
11185 @end table
11186
11187 @noindent
11188 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
11189
11190 @table @code
11191 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
11192 @kindex memset
11193 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
11194 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
11195 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
11196 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
11197 @end table
11198
11199 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
11200 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
11201 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
11202 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
11203
11204
11205 @node Debug Session
11206 @subsection Putting it all together
11207
11208 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
11209 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
11210 steps.
11211
11212 @enumerate
11213 @item
11214 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
11215 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
11216 @display
11217 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
11218 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
11219 @end display
11220
11221 @item
11222 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
11223
11224 @smallexample
11225 set_debug_traps();
11226 breakpoint();
11227 @end smallexample
11228
11229 @item
11230 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
11231 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
11232
11233 @smallexample
11234 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
11235 @end smallexample
11236
11237 @noindent
11238 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
11239 function in your program, that function is called when
11240 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
11241 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
11242 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
11243
11244 @item
11245 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
11246 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
11247
11248 @item
11249 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
11250 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
11251
11252 @item
11253 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
11254 @c document that. FIXME.
11255 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
11256 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
11257
11258 @item
11259 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
11260 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
11261
11262 @end enumerate
11263
11264 @node Configurations
11265 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
11266
11267 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
11268 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
11269 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
11270
11271 There are three major categories of configurations: native
11272 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
11273 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
11274 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
11275 are quite different from each other.
11276
11277 @menu
11278 * Native::
11279 * Embedded OS::
11280 * Embedded Processors::
11281 * Architectures::
11282 @end menu
11283
11284 @node Native
11285 @section Native
11286
11287 This section describes details specific to particular native
11288 configurations.
11289
11290 @menu
11291 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
11292 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
11293 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
11294 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
11295 @end menu
11296
11297 @node HP-UX
11298 @subsection HP-UX
11299
11300 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11301 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11302 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
11303
11304 @node SVR4 Process Information
11305 @subsection SVR4 process information
11306
11307 @kindex /proc
11308 @cindex process image
11309
11310 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11311 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11312 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11313 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11314 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11315 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11316 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
11317 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
11318
11319 @table @code
11320 @kindex info proc
11321 @item info proc
11322 Summarize available information about the process.
11323
11324 @kindex info proc mappings
11325 @item info proc mappings
11326 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11327 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
11328 @ignore
11329 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11330 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11331 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11332 @kindex info proc times
11333 @item info proc times
11334 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11335 its children.
11336
11337 @kindex info proc id
11338 @item info proc id
11339 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11340 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
11341
11342 @kindex info proc status
11343 @item info proc status
11344 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11345 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11346 received.
11347
11348 @item info proc all
11349 Show all the above information about the process.
11350 @end ignore
11351 @end table
11352
11353 @node DJGPP Native
11354 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11355 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11356 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11357 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
11358
11359 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11360 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11361 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11362 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
11363
11364 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11365 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11366 subsection describes those commands.
11367
11368 @table @code
11369 @kindex info dos
11370 @item info dos
11371 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11372 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11373
11374 @kindex sysinfo
11375 @cindex MS-DOS system info
11376 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11377 @item info dos sysinfo
11378 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11379 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11380 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
11381
11382 @cindex GDT
11383 @cindex LDT
11384 @cindex IDT
11385 @cindex segment descriptor tables
11386 @cindex descriptor tables display
11387 @item info dos gdt
11388 @itemx info dos ldt
11389 @itemx info dos idt
11390 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11391 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11392 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11393 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11394 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11395 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11396 rights.
11397
11398 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11399 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11400 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11401 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11402 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
11403
11404 @cindex garbled pointers
11405 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11406 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11407 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11408 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11409 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11410 debugged program's data segment:
11411
11412 @smallexample
11413 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11414 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11415 @end smallexample
11416
11417 @noindent
11418 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11419 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
11420
11421 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11422 @item info dos pde
11423 @itemx info dos pte
11424 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11425 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11426 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11427 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11428 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11429 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11430 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11431 that is currently in use.
11432
11433 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11434 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11435 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11436 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11437 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11438 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11439 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
11440
11441 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11442 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11443 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11444 controller.
11445
11446 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
11447
11448 @cindex physical address from linear address
11449 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11450 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11451 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11452 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11453 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11454 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11455 the variable @code{i} is stored:
11456
11457 @smallexample
11458 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11459 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11460 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11461 @end smallexample
11462
11463 @noindent
11464 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11465 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11466 attributes of that page.
11467
11468 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11469 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11470 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11471 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11472 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11473 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11474
11475 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11476 transfer buffer:
11477
11478 @smallexample
11479 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11480 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11481 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11482 @end smallexample
11483
11484 @noindent
11485 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
11486 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11487 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11488 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11489
11490 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11491 @end table
11492
11493 @node Cygwin Native
11494 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11495 @cindex MS Windows debugging
11496 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
11497 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11498
11499 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
11500 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
11501 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
11502 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
11503 that have no debugging symbols.
11504
11505
11506 @table @code
11507 @kindex info w32
11508 @item info w32
11509 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11510 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11511
11512 @item info w32 selector
11513 This command displays information returned by
11514 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11515 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11516 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11517 Without argument, this command displays information
11518 about the the six segment registers.
11519
11520 @kindex info dll
11521 @item info dll
11522 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11523
11524 @kindex dll-symbols
11525 @item dll-symbols
11526 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11527 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11528
11529 @kindex set new-console
11530 @item set new-console @var{mode}
11531 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11532 be started in a new console on next start.
11533 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11534 be started in the same console as the debugger.
11535
11536 @kindex show new-console
11537 @item show new-console
11538 Displays whether a new console is used
11539 when the debuggee is started.
11540
11541 @kindex set new-group
11542 @item set new-group @var{mode}
11543 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11544 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11545 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11546 Ctrl-C.
11547
11548 @kindex show new-group
11549 @item show new-group
11550 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11551
11552 @kindex set debugevents
11553 @item set debugevents
11554 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11555
11556 @kindex set debugexec
11557 @item set debugexec
11558 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11559 seen by the debugger.
11560
11561 @kindex set debugexceptions
11562 @item set debugexceptions
11563 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11564 seen by the debugger.
11565
11566 @kindex set debugmemory
11567 @item set debugmemory
11568 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11569 seen by the debugger.
11570
11571 @kindex set shell
11572 @item set shell
11573 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11574 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11575
11576 @kindex show shell
11577 @item show shell
11578 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11579
11580 @end table
11581
11582 @menu
11583 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11584 @end menu
11585
11586 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
11587 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11588 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
11589 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
11590
11591 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
11592 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
11593 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
11594 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
11595 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
11596 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
11597 ``minimal symbols''.
11598
11599 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
11600 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
11601 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
11602 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
11603 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
11604 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
11605 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
11606 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
11607 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
11608 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
11609
11610 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
11611
11612 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
11613 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
11614 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
11615 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
11616 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
11617 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
11618 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
11619 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
11620 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
11621
11622 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
11623 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
11624 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
11625 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
11626 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
11627 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
11628
11629 @smallexample
11630 (gdb) info function CreateFileA
11631 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
11632
11633 Non-debugging symbols:
11634 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
11635 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
11636 @end smallexample
11637
11638 @smallexample
11639 (gdb) info function !
11640 All functions matching regular expression "!":
11641
11642 Non-debugging symbols:
11643 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
11644 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
11645 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
11646 [etc...]
11647 @end smallexample
11648
11649 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
11650
11651 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
11652 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
11653 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
11654 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
11655 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
11656 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
11657 a function within a DLL without a running program.
11658
11659 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
11660 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
11661 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
11662 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
11663 problem:
11664
11665 @smallexample
11666 (gdb) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
11667 $1 = 268572168
11668 @end smallexample
11669
11670 @smallexample
11671 (gdb) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
11672 0x10021610: "\230y\""
11673 @end smallexample
11674
11675 And two possible solutions:
11676
11677 @smallexample
11678 (gdb) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
11679 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11680 @end smallexample
11681
11682 @smallexample
11683 (gdb) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
11684 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
11685 (gdb) x/x 0x10021608
11686 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
11687 (gdb) x/s 0x0022fd98
11688 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11689 @end smallexample
11690
11691 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
11692 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
11693 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
11694 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
11695 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
11696
11697 @smallexample
11698 (gdb) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
11699 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
11700 @end smallexample
11701
11702 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
11703 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
11704 safe.
11705
11706 @node Embedded OS
11707 @section Embedded Operating Systems
11708
11709 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11710 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11711 architectures.
11712
11713 @menu
11714 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11715 @end menu
11716
11717 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11718 various real-time operating systems.
11719
11720 @node VxWorks
11721 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11722
11723 @cindex VxWorks
11724
11725 @table @code
11726
11727 @kindex target vxworks
11728 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11729 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11730 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11731
11732 @end table
11733
11734 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11735 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11736
11737 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11738 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11739 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11740 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11741 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11742 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11743 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
11744
11745 @table @code
11746 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11747 @kindex vxworks-timeout
11748 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11749 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11750 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11751 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11752 of a thin network line.
11753 @end table
11754
11755 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11756 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11757 procedures.
11758
11759 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11760 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11761 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11762 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11763 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11764 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11765 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11766 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11767 manual.
11768 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11769
11770 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11771 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11772 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11773 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
11774
11775 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11776
11777 @smallexample
11778 (vxgdb)
11779 @end smallexample
11780
11781 @menu
11782 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11783 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11784 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11785 @end menu
11786
11787 @node VxWorks Connection
11788 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11789
11790 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11791 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11792
11793 @smallexample
11794 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11795 @end smallexample
11796
11797 @need 750
11798 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11799
11800 @smallexample
11801 Attaching remote machine across net...
11802 Connected to tt.
11803 @end smallexample
11804
11805 @need 1000
11806 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11807 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11808 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11809 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11810 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11811
11812 @smallexample
11813 prog.o: No such file or directory.
11814 @end smallexample
11815
11816 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11817 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11818 command again.
11819
11820 @node VxWorks Download
11821 @subsubsection VxWorks download
11822
11823 @cindex download to VxWorks
11824 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11825 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11826 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11827 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11828 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11829 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11830 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11831 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11832 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11833 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11834 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11835 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11836 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11837 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11838 program, type this on VxWorks:
11839
11840 @smallexample
11841 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11842 @end smallexample
11843
11844 @noindent
11845 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11846
11847 @smallexample
11848 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11849 (vxgdb) load prog.o
11850 @end smallexample
11851
11852 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11853
11854 @smallexample
11855 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11856 @end smallexample
11857
11858 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11859 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11860 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11861 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11862 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11863 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11864 table.)
11865
11866 @node VxWorks Attach
11867 @subsubsection Running tasks
11868
11869 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
11870 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11871 follows:
11872
11873 @smallexample
11874 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11875 @end smallexample
11876
11877 @noindent
11878 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11879 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11880 the time of attachment.
11881
11882 @node Embedded Processors
11883 @section Embedded Processors
11884
11885 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11886 configurations.
11887
11888
11889 @menu
11890 * ARM:: ARM
11891 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
11892 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
11893 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
11894 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
11895 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11896 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
11897 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
11898 * PowerPC: PowerPC
11899 * SH:: Renesas SH
11900 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11901 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11902 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11903 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11904 @end menu
11905
11906 @node ARM
11907 @subsection ARM
11908
11909 @table @code
11910
11911 @kindex target rdi
11912 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11913 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11914 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11915 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11916
11917 @kindex target rdp
11918 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11919 ARM Demon monitor.
11920
11921 @end table
11922
11923 @node H8/300
11924 @subsection Renesas H8/300
11925
11926 @table @code
11927
11928 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11929 @item target hms @var{dev}
11930 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11931 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11932 line and the communications speed used.
11933
11934 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11935 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11936 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
11937
11938 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11939 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11940 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11941 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11942 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11943
11944 @end table
11945
11946 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11947 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11948 @cindex download to Renesas SH
11949 @cindex Renesas SH download
11950 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11951 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
11952 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11953 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11954
11955 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11956 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11957
11958 @enumerate
11959 @item
11960 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11961 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11962 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11963 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
11964 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11965
11966 @item
11967 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
11968 serial device available on your host is the default).
11969
11970 @item
11971 what speed to use over the serial device.
11972 @end enumerate
11973
11974 @menu
11975 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
11976 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11977 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
11978 @end menu
11979
11980 @node Renesas Boards
11981 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
11982
11983 @c only for Unix hosts
11984 @kindex device
11985 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
11986 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11987 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11988 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11989 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11990
11991 @kindex speed
11992 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
11993 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11994 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11995 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11996 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11997 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11998
11999 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
12000 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
12001 use a DOS host,
12002 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
12003 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
12004 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
12005 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
12006
12007 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
12008 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
12009 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
12010 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
12011
12012 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
12013 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
12014 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
12015 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
12016 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
12017 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
12018 @code{COM2}.
12019
12020 @smallexample
12021 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
12022 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
12023
12024 Resident portion of MODE loaded
12025
12026 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
12027
12028 @end smallexample
12029
12030 @quotation
12031 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
12032 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
12033 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
12034 your development board.
12035 @end quotation
12036
12037 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
12038 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
12039 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
12040 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
12041 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
12042 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
12043 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
12044 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
12045 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
12046 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
12047 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
12048 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
12049 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
12050
12051 @smallexample
12052 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
12053 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
12054 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
12055 the conditions.
12056 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
12057 for details.
12058 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
12059 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
12060 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
12061 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
12062 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
12063 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
12064 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
12065 @end smallexample
12066
12067 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
12068 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
12069 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
12070 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
12071 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
12072 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
12073
12074 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
12075 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
12076 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
12077
12078 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
12079 @itemize @bullet
12080 @item
12081 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
12082 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
12083
12084 @item
12085 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
12086 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
12087 to detect program completion.
12088 @end itemize
12089
12090 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
12091 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
12092
12093 @node Renesas ICE
12094 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
12095
12096 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
12097 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
12098 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
12099 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
12100
12101 @table @code
12102 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
12103 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
12104 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
12105 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
12106 (for example, @samp{9600}).
12107
12108 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
12109 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
12110 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
12111 @end table
12112
12113 @node Renesas Special
12114 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
12115
12116 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
12117
12118 @table @code
12119
12120 @kindex set machine
12121 @kindex show machine
12122 @item set machine h8300
12123 @itemx set machine h8300h
12124 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
12125 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
12126 to check which variant is currently in effect.
12127
12128 @end table
12129
12130 @node H8/500
12131 @subsection H8/500
12132
12133 @table @code
12134
12135 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
12136 @cindex memory models, H8/500
12137 @item set memory @var{mod}
12138 @itemx show memory
12139 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
12140 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
12141 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
12142 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
12143
12144 @end table
12145
12146 @node M32R/D
12147 @subsection Renesas M32R/D
12148
12149 @table @code
12150
12151 @kindex target m32r
12152 @item target m32r @var{dev}
12153 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
12154
12155 @kindex target m32rsdi
12156 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
12157 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
12158
12159 @end table
12160
12161 @node M68K
12162 @subsection M68k
12163
12164 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
12165 target command for the following ROM monitors.
12166
12167 @table @code
12168
12169 @kindex target abug
12170 @item target abug @var{dev}
12171 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
12172
12173 @kindex target cpu32bug
12174 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
12175 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12176
12177 @kindex target dbug
12178 @item target dbug @var{dev}
12179 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
12180
12181 @kindex target est
12182 @item target est @var{dev}
12183 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12184
12185 @kindex target rom68k
12186 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
12187 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
12188
12189 @end table
12190
12191 @table @code
12192
12193 @kindex target rombug
12194 @item target rombug @var{dev}
12195 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
12196
12197 @end table
12198
12199 @node MIPS Embedded
12200 @subsection MIPS Embedded
12201
12202 @cindex MIPS boards
12203 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
12204 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
12205 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
12206
12207 @need 1000
12208 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
12209
12210 @table @code
12211 @item target mips @var{port}
12212 @kindex target mips @var{port}
12213 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
12214 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
12215 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
12216 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
12217 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
12218 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
12219
12220 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
12221 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
12222 debugger:
12223
12224 @smallexample
12225 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
12226 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
12227 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
12228 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
12229 (@value{GDBP}) run
12230 @end smallexample
12231
12232 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
12233 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
12234 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
12235 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
12236 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12237
12238 @item target pmon @var{port}
12239 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
12240 PMON ROM monitor.
12241
12242 @item target ddb @var{port}
12243 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
12244 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
12245
12246 @item target lsi @var{port}
12247 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
12248 LSI variant of PMON.
12249
12250 @kindex target r3900
12251 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
12252 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
12253
12254 @kindex target array
12255 @item target array @var{dev}
12256 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
12257
12258 @end table
12259
12260
12261 @noindent
12262 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
12263
12264 @table @code
12265 @item set processor @var{args}
12266 @itemx show processor
12267 @kindex set processor @var{args}
12268 @kindex show processor
12269 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
12270 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
12271 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
12272 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
12273 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
12274 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
12275 @value{GDBN} is using.
12276
12277 @item set mipsfpu double
12278 @itemx set mipsfpu single
12279 @itemx set mipsfpu none
12280 @itemx show mipsfpu
12281 @kindex set mipsfpu
12282 @kindex show mipsfpu
12283 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
12284 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12285 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12286 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
12287 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
12288 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12289 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12290 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12291 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12292 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12293 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12294 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12295 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
12296
12297 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12298 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12299 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
12300
12301 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12302 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
12303
12304 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
12305 @itemx show remotedebug
12306 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12307 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12308 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12309 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12310 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12311 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12312 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12313 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12314 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12315 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12316 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
12317
12318 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
12319 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12320 @itemx show timeout
12321 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
12322 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12323 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12324 @kindex set timeout
12325 @kindex show timeout
12326 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
12327 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
12328 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12329 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12330 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12331 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12332 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12333 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12334 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12335 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12336
12337 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12338 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12339 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12340 to run before stopping.
12341 @end table
12342
12343 @node OpenRISC 1000
12344 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
12345 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
12346
12347 @cindex or1k boards
12348 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
12349 about platform and commands.
12350
12351 @table @code
12352
12353 @kindex target jtag
12354 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
12355
12356 Connects to remote JTAG server.
12357 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
12358 connected via parallel port to the board.
12359
12360 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
12361
12362 @kindex or1ksim
12363 @item or1ksim @var{command}
12364 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
12365 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
12366
12367 @kindex info or1k spr
12368 @item info or1k spr
12369 Displays spr groups.
12370
12371 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
12372 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
12373 Displays register names in selected group.
12374
12375 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
12376 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
12377 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
12378 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
12379 Shows information about specified spr register.
12380
12381 @kindex spr
12382 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
12383 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
12384 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
12385 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
12386 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
12387 @end table
12388
12389 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
12390 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
12391 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
12392 triggers can be set using:
12393 @table @code
12394 @item $LEA/$LDATA
12395 Load effective address/data
12396 @item $SEA/$SDATA
12397 Store effective address/data
12398 @item $AEA/$ADATA
12399 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
12400 @item $FETCH
12401 Fetch data
12402 @end table
12403
12404 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
12405 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
12406
12407 @code{htrace} commands:
12408 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
12409 @table @code
12410 @kindex hwatch
12411 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
12412 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
12413 or Data. For example:
12414
12415 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12416
12417 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12418
12419 @kindex htrace info
12420 @item htrace info
12421 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
12422
12423 @kindex htrace trigger
12424 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
12425 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
12426
12427 @kindex htrace qualifier
12428 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
12429 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
12430
12431 @kindex htrace stop
12432 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
12433 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
12434
12435 @kindex htrace record
12436 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
12437 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
12438 triggered.
12439
12440 @kindex htrace enable
12441 @item htrace enable
12442 @kindex htrace disable
12443 @itemx htrace disable
12444 Enables/disables the HW trace.
12445
12446 @kindex htrace rewind
12447 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
12448 Clears currently recorded trace data.
12449
12450 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
12451 will be written there.
12452
12453 @kindex htrace print
12454 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
12455 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
12456
12457 @kindex htrace mode continuous
12458 @item htrace mode continuous
12459 Set continuous trace mode.
12460
12461 @kindex htrace mode suspend
12462 @item htrace mode suspend
12463 Set suspend trace mode.
12464
12465 @end table
12466
12467 @node PowerPC
12468 @subsection PowerPC
12469
12470 @table @code
12471
12472 @kindex target dink32
12473 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
12474 DINK32 ROM monitor.
12475
12476 @kindex target ppcbug
12477 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12478 @kindex target ppcbug1
12479 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12480 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12481
12482 @kindex target sds
12483 @item target sds @var{dev}
12484 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12485
12486 @end table
12487
12488 @node PA
12489 @subsection HP PA Embedded
12490
12491 @table @code
12492
12493 @kindex target op50n
12494 @item target op50n @var{dev}
12495 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12496
12497 @kindex target w89k
12498 @item target w89k @var{dev}
12499 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12500
12501 @end table
12502
12503 @node SH
12504 @subsection Renesas SH
12505
12506 @table @code
12507
12508 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
12509 @item target hms @var{dev}
12510 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12511 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12512 the communications speed used.
12513
12514 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
12515 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
12516 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
12517
12518 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12519 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12520 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
12521 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
12522 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12523
12524 @end table
12525
12526 @node Sparclet
12527 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12528
12529 @cindex Sparclet
12530
12531 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12532 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12533 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12534 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12535 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
12536
12537 @table @code
12538 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
12539 @kindex remotetimeout
12540 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12541 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12542 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
12543 @end table
12544
12545 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12546 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12547 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12548 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12549 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
12550
12551 @smallexample
12552 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12553 @end smallexample
12554
12555 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
12556
12557 @smallexample
12558 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12559 @end smallexample
12560
12561 @cindex running, on Sparclet
12562 Once you have set
12563 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12564 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12565 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12566
12567 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12568
12569 @smallexample
12570 (gdbslet)
12571 @end smallexample
12572
12573 @menu
12574 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12575 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12576 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12577 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
12578 @end menu
12579
12580 @node Sparclet File
12581 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
12582
12583 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12584
12585 @smallexample
12586 (gdbslet) file prog
12587 @end smallexample
12588
12589 @need 1000
12590 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12591 @value{GDBN} locates
12592 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12593 path.
12594 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12595 files will be searched as well.
12596 @value{GDBN} locates
12597 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12598 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12599 If it fails
12600 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12601
12602 @smallexample
12603 prog: No such file or directory.
12604 @end smallexample
12605
12606 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12607 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12608 @code{target} command again.
12609
12610 @node Sparclet Connection
12611 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12612
12613 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12614 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12615
12616 @smallexample
12617 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12618 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12619 main () at ../prog.c:3
12620 @end smallexample
12621
12622 @need 750
12623 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12624
12625 @smallexample
12626 Connected to ttya.
12627 @end smallexample
12628
12629 @node Sparclet Download
12630 @subsubsection Sparclet download
12631
12632 @cindex download to Sparclet
12633 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12634 you can use the @value{GDBN}
12635 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12636 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12637 command.
12638 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12639 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12640 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12641 of each of the file's sections.
12642 For instance, if the program
12643 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12644 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12645
12646 @smallexample
12647 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12648 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12649 @end smallexample
12650
12651 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12652 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12653 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12654
12655 @node Sparclet Execution
12656 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12657
12658 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12659 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12660 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12661 manual for the list of commands.
12662
12663 @smallexample
12664 (gdbslet) b main
12665 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12666 (gdbslet) run
12667 Starting program: prog
12668 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12669 3 char *symarg = 0;
12670 (gdbslet) step
12671 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12672 (gdbslet)
12673 @end smallexample
12674
12675 @node Sparclite
12676 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12677
12678 @table @code
12679
12680 @kindex target sparclite
12681 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12682 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12683 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12684 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12685 remote protocol.
12686
12687 @end table
12688
12689 @node ST2000
12690 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12691
12692 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12693 STDBUG protocol.
12694
12695 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12696 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12697
12698 @smallexample
12699 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12700 @end smallexample
12701
12702 @noindent
12703 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12704 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12705 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12706 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12707 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12708
12709 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12710 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12711 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12712 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12713 available on your host computer.
12714 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12715 @c basically hearsay.
12716
12717 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12718 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12719 environment:
12720
12721 @table @code
12722 @item st2000 @var{command}
12723 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12724 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12725 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12726 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12727 manual for available commands.
12728
12729 @item connect
12730 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12731 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12732 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12733 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12734 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12735 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12736 @end table
12737
12738 @node Z8000
12739 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12740
12741 @cindex Z8000
12742 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12743 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12744
12745 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12746 a Z8000 simulator.
12747
12748 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12749 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12750 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12751 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12752
12753 @table @code
12754 @item target sim @var{args}
12755 @kindex sim
12756 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12757 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12758 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12759 @end table
12760
12761 @noindent
12762 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12763 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12764 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12765 to run your program, and so on.
12766
12767 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12768 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12769 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12770
12771 @table @code
12772
12773 @item cycles
12774 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12775
12776 @item insts
12777 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12778
12779 @item time
12780 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12781
12782 @end table
12783
12784 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12785 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12786 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12787 simulated clock ticks.
12788
12789 @node Architectures
12790 @section Architectures
12791
12792 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12793 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12794
12795 @menu
12796 * A29K::
12797 * Alpha::
12798 * MIPS::
12799 @end menu
12800
12801 @node A29K
12802 @subsection A29K
12803
12804 @table @code
12805
12806 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12807 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12808 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12809 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12810 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12811 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12812 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12813 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12814 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12815 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12816 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12817 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12818 hexadecimal.
12819
12820 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12821 @item show rstack_high_address
12822 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12823 processors.
12824
12825 @end table
12826
12827 @node Alpha
12828 @subsection Alpha
12829
12830 See the following section.
12831
12832 @node MIPS
12833 @subsection MIPS
12834
12835 @cindex stack on Alpha
12836 @cindex stack on MIPS
12837 @cindex Alpha stack
12838 @cindex MIPS stack
12839 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12840 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12841 find the beginning of a function.
12842
12843 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12844 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12845 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12846 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12847 commands:
12848
12849 @table @code
12850 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12851 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12852 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12853 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12854 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12855 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12856 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12857
12858 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12859 Display the current limit.
12860 @end table
12861
12862 @noindent
12863 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12864 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12865
12866
12867 @node Controlling GDB
12868 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12869
12870 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12871 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12872 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12873 described here.
12874
12875 @menu
12876 * Prompt:: Prompt
12877 * Editing:: Command editing
12878 * History:: Command history
12879 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12880 * Numbers:: Numbers
12881 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
12882 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12883 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12884 @end menu
12885
12886 @node Prompt
12887 @section Prompt
12888
12889 @cindex prompt
12890
12891 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12892 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12893 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12894 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12895 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12896 which one you are talking to.
12897
12898 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12899 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12900 or a prompt that does not.
12901
12902 @table @code
12903 @kindex set prompt
12904 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12905 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12906
12907 @kindex show prompt
12908 @item show prompt
12909 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12910 @end table
12911
12912 @node Editing
12913 @section Command editing
12914 @cindex readline
12915 @cindex command line editing
12916
12917 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12918 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12919 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12920 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12921 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12922 debugging sessions.
12923
12924 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12925 command @code{set}.
12926
12927 @table @code
12928 @kindex set editing
12929 @cindex editing
12930 @item set editing
12931 @itemx set editing on
12932 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12933
12934 @item set editing off
12935 Disable command line editing.
12936
12937 @kindex show editing
12938 @item show editing
12939 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12940 @end table
12941
12942 @node History
12943 @section Command history
12944
12945 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12946 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12947 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12948 history facility.
12949
12950 @table @code
12951 @cindex history substitution
12952 @cindex history file
12953 @kindex set history filename
12954 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12955 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12956 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12957 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12958 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12959 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12960 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12961 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12962 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12963 is not set.
12964
12965 @cindex history save
12966 @kindex set history save
12967 @item set history save
12968 @itemx set history save on
12969 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12970 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12971
12972 @item set history save off
12973 Stop recording command history in a file.
12974
12975 @cindex history size
12976 @kindex set history size
12977 @item set history size @var{size}
12978 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12979 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12980 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12981 @end table
12982
12983 @cindex history expansion
12984 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12985 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12986 @xref{Event Designators}.
12987 @end ifset
12988
12989 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12990 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12991 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12992 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12993 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12994 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12995 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12996
12997 The commands to control history expansion are:
12998
12999 @table @code
13000 @kindex set history expansion
13001 @item set history expansion on
13002 @itemx set history expansion
13003 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
13004
13005 @item set history expansion off
13006 Disable history expansion.
13007
13008 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
13009 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
13010 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
13011 @ifset have-readline-appendices
13012 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
13013 @end ifset
13014
13015 @c @group
13016 @kindex show history
13017 @item show history
13018 @itemx show history filename
13019 @itemx show history save
13020 @itemx show history size
13021 @itemx show history expansion
13022 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
13023 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
13024 @c @end group
13025 @end table
13026
13027 @table @code
13028 @kindex shows
13029 @item show commands
13030 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
13031
13032 @item show commands @var{n}
13033 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
13034
13035 @item show commands +
13036 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
13037 @end table
13038
13039 @node Screen Size
13040 @section Screen size
13041 @cindex size of screen
13042 @cindex pauses in output
13043
13044 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
13045 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
13046 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
13047 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
13048 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
13049 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
13050 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
13051 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
13052
13053 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
13054 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
13055 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
13056 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
13057 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
13058 width} commands:
13059
13060 @table @code
13061 @kindex set height
13062 @kindex set width
13063 @kindex show width
13064 @kindex show height
13065 @item set height @var{lpp}
13066 @itemx show height
13067 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
13068 @itemx show width
13069 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
13070 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
13071 commands display the current settings.
13072
13073 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
13074 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
13075 file or to an editor buffer.
13076
13077 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
13078 from wrapping its output.
13079 @end table
13080
13081 @node Numbers
13082 @section Numbers
13083 @cindex number representation
13084 @cindex entering numbers
13085
13086 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
13087 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
13088 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
13089 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
13090 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
13091 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
13092 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
13093 radix} command.
13094
13095 @table @code
13096 @kindex set input-radix
13097 @item set input-radix @var{base}
13098 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
13099 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
13100 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
13101 example, any of
13102
13103 @smallexample
13104 set radix 012
13105 set radix 10.
13106 set radix 0xa
13107 @end smallexample
13108
13109 @noindent
13110 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
13111 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
13112
13113 @kindex set output-radix
13114 @item set output-radix @var{base}
13115 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
13116 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
13117 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
13118
13119 @kindex show input-radix
13120 @item show input-radix
13121 Display the current default base for numeric input.
13122
13123 @kindex show output-radix
13124 @item show output-radix
13125 Display the current default base for numeric display.
13126 @end table
13127
13128 @node ABI
13129 @section Configuring the current ABI
13130
13131 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
13132 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
13133 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
13134 current ABI.
13135
13136 @cindex OS ABI
13137 @kindex set osabi
13138 @kindex show osabi
13139
13140 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
13141 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
13142 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
13143 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
13144 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
13145 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
13146 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
13147 platform provides.
13148
13149 @table @code
13150 @item show osabi
13151 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
13152
13153 @item set osabi
13154 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
13155
13156 @item set osabi @var{abi}
13157 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
13158 @end table
13159
13160 @cindex float promotion
13161 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
13162
13163 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
13164 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
13165 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
13166 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
13167 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
13168 @code{double} and then passed.
13169
13170 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
13171 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
13172 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
13173
13174 @table @code
13175 @item set coerce-float-to-double
13176 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
13177 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
13178 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
13179
13180 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
13181 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
13182 functions.
13183 @end table
13184
13185 @kindex set cp-abi
13186 @kindex show cp-abi
13187 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
13188 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
13189 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
13190 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
13191 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
13192 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
13193 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
13194 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
13195 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
13196 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
13197 ``auto''.
13198
13199 @table @code
13200 @item show cp-abi
13201 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
13202
13203 @item set cp-abi
13204 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
13205
13206 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
13207 @itemx set cp-abi auto
13208 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
13209 @end table
13210
13211 @node Messages/Warnings
13212 @section Optional warnings and messages
13213
13214 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
13215 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
13216 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
13217 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
13218
13219 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
13220 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
13221 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
13222
13223 @table @code
13224 @kindex set verbose
13225 @item set verbose on
13226 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13227
13228 @item set verbose off
13229 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13230
13231 @kindex show verbose
13232 @item show verbose
13233 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
13234 @end table
13235
13236 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
13237 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
13238 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
13239 symbol files}).
13240
13241 @table @code
13242
13243 @kindex set complaints
13244 @item set complaints @var{limit}
13245 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
13246 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
13247 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
13248 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
13249
13250 @kindex show complaints
13251 @item show complaints
13252 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
13253
13254 @end table
13255
13256 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
13257 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
13258 you try to run a program which is already running:
13259
13260 @smallexample
13261 (@value{GDBP}) run
13262 The program being debugged has been started already.
13263 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
13264 @end smallexample
13265
13266 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
13267 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
13268
13269 @table @code
13270
13271 @kindex set confirm
13272 @cindex flinching
13273 @cindex confirmation
13274 @cindex stupid questions
13275 @item set confirm off
13276 Disables confirmation requests.
13277
13278 @item set confirm on
13279 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
13280
13281 @kindex show confirm
13282 @item show confirm
13283 Displays state of confirmation requests.
13284
13285 @end table
13286
13287 @node Debugging Output
13288 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
13289 @table @code
13290 @kindex set debug arch
13291 @item set debug arch
13292 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
13293 @kindex show debug arch
13294 @item show debug arch
13295 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
13296 @kindex set debug event
13297 @item set debug event
13298 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
13299 default is off.
13300 @kindex show debug event
13301 @item show debug event
13302 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
13303 info.
13304 @kindex set debug expression
13305 @item set debug expression
13306 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
13307 default is off.
13308 @kindex show debug expression
13309 @item show debug expression
13310 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
13311 debugging info.
13312 @kindex set debug frame
13313 @item set debug frame
13314 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
13315 default is off.
13316 @kindex show debug frame
13317 @item show debug frame
13318 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
13319 info.
13320 @kindex set debug overload
13321 @item set debug overload
13322 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
13323 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13324 is off.
13325 @kindex show debug overload
13326 @item show debug overload
13327 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
13328 debugging info.
13329 @kindex set debug remote
13330 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13331 @cindex serial connections, debugging
13332 @item set debug remote
13333 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13334 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13335 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13336 @kindex show debug remote
13337 @item show debug remote
13338 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13339 @kindex set debug serial
13340 @item set debug serial
13341 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13342 default is off.
13343 @kindex show debug serial
13344 @item show debug serial
13345 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13346 info.
13347 @kindex set debug target
13348 @item set debug target
13349 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13350 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13351 default is off.
13352 @kindex show debug target
13353 @item show debug target
13354 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13355 info.
13356 @kindex set debug varobj
13357 @item set debug varobj
13358 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13359 info. The default is off.
13360 @kindex show debug varobj
13361 @item show debug varobj
13362 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13363 debugging info.
13364 @end table
13365
13366 @node Sequences
13367 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
13368
13369 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13370 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13371 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13372 files.
13373
13374 @menu
13375 * Define:: User-defined commands
13376 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13377 * Command Files:: Command files
13378 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
13379 @end menu
13380
13381 @node Define
13382 @section User-defined commands
13383
13384 @cindex user-defined command
13385 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13386 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13387 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13388 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13389 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
13390
13391 @smallexample
13392 define adder
13393 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13394 @end smallexample
13395
13396 @noindent
13397 To execute the command use:
13398
13399 @smallexample
13400 adder 1 2 3
13401 @end smallexample
13402
13403 @noindent
13404 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13405 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13406 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13407 functions calls.
13408
13409 @table @code
13410
13411 @kindex define
13412 @item define @var{commandname}
13413 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13414 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
13415
13416 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13417 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13418 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13419
13420 @kindex if
13421 @kindex else
13422 @item if
13423 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13424 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13425 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13426 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13427 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13428 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13429
13430 @kindex while
13431 @item while
13432 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13433 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13434 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13435 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13436 evaluates to true.
13437
13438 @kindex document
13439 @item document @var{commandname}
13440 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13441 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13442 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13443 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13444 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13445 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
13446
13447 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13448 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13449 does not change the documentation.
13450
13451 @kindex help user-defined
13452 @item help user-defined
13453 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13454 (if any) for each.
13455
13456 @kindex show user
13457 @item show user
13458 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
13459 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13460 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13461 definitions for all user-defined commands.
13462
13463 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
13464 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
13465 @item show max-user-call-depth
13466 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
13467 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13468 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13469 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
13470
13471 @end table
13472
13473 When user-defined commands are executed, the
13474 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13475 stops execution of the user-defined command.
13476
13477 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13478 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13479 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13480 messages when used in a user-defined command.
13481
13482 @node Hooks
13483 @section User-defined command hooks
13484 @cindex command hooks
13485 @cindex hooks, for commands
13486 @cindex hooks, pre-command
13487
13488 @kindex hook
13489 @kindex hook-
13490 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13491 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13492 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13493 before that command.
13494
13495 @cindex hooks, post-command
13496 @kindex hookpost
13497 @kindex hookpost-
13498 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13499 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13500 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13501 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13502 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
13503
13504 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13505 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
13506
13507 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13508 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
13509
13510 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13511 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13512 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13513 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13514 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
13515
13516 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13517 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13518 you could define:
13519
13520 @smallexample
13521 define hook-stop
13522 handle SIGALRM nopass
13523 end
13524
13525 define hook-run
13526 handle SIGALRM pass
13527 end
13528
13529 define hook-continue
13530 handle SIGLARM pass
13531 end
13532 @end smallexample
13533
13534 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13535 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13536 you could define:
13537
13538 @smallexample
13539 define hook-echo
13540 echo <<<---
13541 end
13542
13543 define hookpost-echo
13544 echo --->>>\n
13545 end
13546
13547 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13548 <<<---Hello World--->>>
13549 (@value{GDBP})
13550
13551 @end smallexample
13552
13553 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13554 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13555 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13556 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13557 @c or not?
13558 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13559 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13560 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13561
13562 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13563 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13564
13565 @node Command Files
13566 @section Command files
13567
13568 @cindex command files
13569 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13570 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13571 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13572 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13573
13574 @cindex init file
13575 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13576 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13577 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13578 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13579 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13580 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13581 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
13582
13583 @enumerate
13584 @item
13585 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13586 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13587 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13588
13589 @item
13590 Processes command line options and operands.
13591
13592 @item
13593 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13594
13595 @item
13596 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13597 @end enumerate
13598
13599 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13600 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13601 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13602 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
13603
13604 @cindex init file name
13605 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13606 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13607 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13608 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13609 environments with special init file names:
13610
13611 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13612 @itemize @bullet
13613 @item
13614 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
13615
13616 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13617 @item
13618 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
13619
13620 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13621 @item
13622 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13623 @end itemize
13624
13625 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13626 @code{source} command:
13627
13628 @table @code
13629 @kindex source
13630 @item source @var{filename}
13631 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13632 @end table
13633
13634 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13635 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13636 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
13637
13638 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13639 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13640 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13641 when called from command files.
13642
13643 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13644 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13645 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13646 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13647 the next command.
13648
13649 @smallexample
13650 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13651 @end smallexample
13652
13653 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13654 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13655 would be directed to @file{log}.
13656
13657 @node Output
13658 @section Commands for controlled output
13659
13660 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13661 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13662 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13663 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13664 want.
13665
13666 @table @code
13667 @kindex echo
13668 @item echo @var{text}
13669 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13670 @c because it is not in ANSI.
13671 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13672 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13673 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13674 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13675 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13676 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13677 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13678 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13679 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13680
13681 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13682 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13683
13684 @smallexample
13685 echo This is some text\n\
13686 which is continued\n\
13687 onto several lines.\n
13688 @end smallexample
13689
13690 produces the same output as
13691
13692 @smallexample
13693 echo This is some text\n
13694 echo which is continued\n
13695 echo onto several lines.\n
13696 @end smallexample
13697
13698 @kindex output
13699 @item output @var{expression}
13700 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13701 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13702 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13703 on expressions.
13704
13705 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13706 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13707 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13708 formats}, for more information.
13709
13710 @kindex printf
13711 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13712 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13713 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13714 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13715 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13716 subroutine
13717 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13718 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13719 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13720 @c supported.
13721
13722 @smallexample
13723 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13724 @end smallexample
13725
13726 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13727
13728 @smallexample
13729 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13730 @end smallexample
13731
13732 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13733 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13734 letter.
13735 @end table
13736
13737 @node Interpreters
13738 @chapter Command Interpreters
13739 @cindex command interpreters
13740
13741 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13742 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13743 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13744
13745 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13746 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13747 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13748 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13749
13750 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13751 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13752 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13753 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13754
13755 @table @code
13756 @item console
13757 @cindex console interpreter
13758 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13759 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13760 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13761
13762 @item mi
13763 @cindex mi interpreter
13764 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13765 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13766 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13767 Interface}.
13768
13769 @item mi2
13770 @cindex mi2 interpreter
13771 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13772
13773 @item mi1
13774 @cindex mi1 interpreter
13775 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13776
13777 @end table
13778
13779 @cindex invoke another interpreter
13780 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13781 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13782 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13783 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13784 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13785 the IDE inoperable!
13786
13787 @kindex interpreter-exec
13788 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13789 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13790 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13791 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
13792
13793 @smallexample
13794 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13795 @end smallexample
13796
13797 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13798 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13799
13800 @node TUI
13801 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13802 @cindex TUI
13803
13804 @menu
13805 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13806 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13807 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
13808 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13809 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13810 @end menu
13811
13812 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13813 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13814 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13815 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13816 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13817 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13818
13819 @node TUI Overview
13820 @section TUI overview
13821
13822 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13823 @value{GDBN} runs:
13824
13825 @itemize @bullet
13826 @item
13827 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13828 windows on the terminal.
13829
13830 @item
13831 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13832 the TUI.
13833 @end itemize
13834
13835 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13836 on the terminal:
13837
13838 @table @emph
13839 @item command
13840 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13841 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13842 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13843 window is always visible.
13844
13845 @item source
13846 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13847 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13848
13849 @item assembly
13850 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13851
13852 @item register
13853 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13854 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13855 changed are highlighted.
13856
13857 @end table
13858
13859 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13860 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13861 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13862 indicates the breakpoint type:
13863
13864 @table @code
13865 @item B
13866 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13867
13868 @item b
13869 Breakpoint which was never hit.
13870
13871 @item H
13872 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13873
13874 @item h
13875 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13876
13877 @end table
13878
13879 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13880
13881 @table @code
13882 @item +
13883 Breakpoint is enabled.
13884
13885 @item -
13886 Breakpoint is disabled.
13887
13888 @end table
13889
13890 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13891 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13892 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13893 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13894 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13895 The following layouts are available:
13896
13897 @itemize @bullet
13898 @item
13899 source
13900
13901 @item
13902 assembly
13903
13904 @item
13905 source and assembly
13906
13907 @item
13908 source and registers
13909
13910 @item
13911 assembly and registers
13912
13913 @end itemize
13914
13915 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13916 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13917 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13918 are displayed:
13919
13920 @table @emph
13921 @item target
13922 Indicates the current gdb target
13923 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13924
13925 @item process
13926 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13927 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13928
13929 @item function
13930 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13931 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13932 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13933 the string @code{??} is displayed.
13934
13935 @item line
13936 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13937 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13938
13939 @item pc
13940 Indicates the current program counter address.
13941
13942 @end table
13943
13944 @node TUI Keys
13945 @section TUI Key Bindings
13946 @cindex TUI key bindings
13947
13948 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13949 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13950 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13951 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13952 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13953 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
13954 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13955
13956 @table @kbd
13957 @kindex C-x C-a
13958 @item C-x C-a
13959 @kindex C-x a
13960 @itemx C-x a
13961 @kindex C-x A
13962 @itemx C-x A
13963 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13964 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13965 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13966 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13967 The screen is then refreshed.
13968
13969 @kindex C-x 1
13970 @item C-x 1
13971 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13972 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13973 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13974
13975 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13976
13977 @kindex C-x 2
13978 @item C-x 2
13979 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13980 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13981 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13982 previous layout and the new one.
13983
13984 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13985
13986 @kindex C-x o
13987 @item C-x o
13988 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
13989 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
13990 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
13991
13992 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
13993
13994 @kindex C-x s
13995 @item C-x s
13996 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13997 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13998
13999 @end table
14000
14001 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
14002
14003 @table @key
14004 @kindex PgUp
14005 @item PgUp
14006 Scroll the active window one page up.
14007
14008 @kindex PgDn
14009 @item PgDn
14010 Scroll the active window one page down.
14011
14012 @kindex Up
14013 @item Up
14014 Scroll the active window one line up.
14015
14016 @kindex Down
14017 @item Down
14018 Scroll the active window one line down.
14019
14020 @kindex Left
14021 @item Left
14022 Scroll the active window one column left.
14023
14024 @kindex Right
14025 @item Right
14026 Scroll the active window one column right.
14027
14028 @kindex C-L
14029 @item C-L
14030 Refresh the screen.
14031
14032 @end table
14033
14034 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
14035 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
14036 active window is the command window. When the command window
14037 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
14038 key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
14039
14040 @node TUI Single Key Mode
14041 @section TUI Single Key Mode
14042 @cindex TUI single key mode
14043
14044 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
14045 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
14046 some gdb commands.
14047
14048 @table @kbd
14049 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14050 @item c
14051 continue
14052
14053 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14054 @item d
14055 down
14056
14057 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14058 @item f
14059 finish
14060
14061 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14062 @item n
14063 next
14064
14065 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14066 @item q
14067 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
14068
14069 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14070 @item r
14071 run
14072
14073 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14074 @item s
14075 step
14076
14077 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14078 @item u
14079 up
14080
14081 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14082 @item v
14083 info locals
14084
14085 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
14086 @item w
14087 where
14088
14089 @end table
14090
14091 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
14092 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
14093 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
14094 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
14095 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
14096 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
14097
14098
14099 @node TUI Commands
14100 @section TUI specific commands
14101 @cindex TUI commands
14102
14103 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
14104 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
14105 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
14106 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
14107 in the TUI mode.
14108
14109 @table @code
14110 @item info win
14111 @kindex info win
14112 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
14113
14114 @item layout next
14115 @kindex layout next
14116 Display the next layout.
14117
14118 @item layout prev
14119 @kindex layout prev
14120 Display the previous layout.
14121
14122 @item layout src
14123 @kindex layout src
14124 Display the source window only.
14125
14126 @item layout asm
14127 @kindex layout asm
14128 Display the assembly window only.
14129
14130 @item layout split
14131 @kindex layout split
14132 Display the source and assembly window.
14133
14134 @item layout regs
14135 @kindex layout regs
14136 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
14137
14138 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
14139 @kindex focus
14140 Set the focus to the named window.
14141 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
14142 can be affected to another window.
14143
14144 @item refresh
14145 @kindex refresh
14146 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
14147
14148 @item update
14149 @kindex update
14150 Update the source window and the current execution point.
14151
14152 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
14153 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
14154 @kindex winheight
14155 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
14156 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
14157 decrease it.
14158
14159 @end table
14160
14161 @node TUI Configuration
14162 @section TUI configuration variables
14163 @cindex TUI configuration variables
14164
14165 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
14166 appearance of windows on the terminal.
14167
14168 @table @code
14169 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
14170 @kindex set tui border-kind
14171 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
14172 The possible values are the following:
14173 @table @code
14174 @item space
14175 Use a space character to draw the border.
14176
14177 @item ascii
14178 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
14179
14180 @item acs
14181 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
14182 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
14183
14184 @end table
14185
14186 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
14187 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
14188 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
14189 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
14190 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
14191
14192 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
14193 @kindex set tui border-mode
14194 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
14195 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
14196 @table @code
14197 @item normal
14198 Use normal attributes to display the border.
14199
14200 @item standout
14201 Use standout mode.
14202
14203 @item reverse
14204 Use reverse video mode.
14205
14206 @item half
14207 Use half bright mode.
14208
14209 @item half-standout
14210 Use half bright and standout mode.
14211
14212 @item bold
14213 Use extra bright or bold mode.
14214
14215 @item bold-standout
14216 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
14217
14218 @end table
14219
14220 @end table
14221
14222 @node Emacs
14223 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
14224
14225 @cindex Emacs
14226 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
14227 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
14228 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
14229 @value{GDBN}.
14230
14231 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
14232 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
14233 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
14234 created Emacs buffer.
14235 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
14236
14237 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
14238 things:
14239
14240 @itemize @bullet
14241 @item
14242 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
14243 @end itemize
14244
14245 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
14246 and output done by the program you are debugging.
14247
14248 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
14249 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
14250 in this way.
14251
14252 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
14253 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
14254 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
14255 stop.
14256
14257 @itemize @bullet
14258 @item
14259 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
14260 @end itemize
14261
14262 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
14263 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
14264 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
14265 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
14266 and the source.
14267
14268 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
14269 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
14270
14271 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
14272 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
14273 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
14274 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
14275 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
14276 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
14277 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
14278 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
14279 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
14280
14281 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
14282 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
14283 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
14284 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
14285
14286 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
14287 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
14288 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
14289 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
14290 one you want.
14291
14292 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
14293 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
14294
14295 @table @kbd
14296 @item C-h m
14297 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
14298
14299 @item C-c C-s
14300 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
14301 update the display window to show the current file and location.
14302
14303 @item C-c C-n
14304 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
14305 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
14306 to show the current file and location.
14307
14308 @item C-c C-i
14309 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
14310 display window accordingly.
14311
14312 @item C-c C-f
14313 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
14314 @code{finish} command.
14315
14316 @item C-c C-r
14317 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
14318 command.
14319
14320 @item C-c <
14321 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
14322 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
14323 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
14324
14325 @item C-c >
14326 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
14327 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
14328 @end table
14329
14330 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gud-break})
14331 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
14332
14333 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
14334 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
14335 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
14336 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
14337 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
14338 current one.
14339
14340 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14341 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14342 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14343 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14344 frame.
14345
14346 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14347 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14348 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14349 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14350 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14351 to correspond properly with the code.
14352
14353 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
14354 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
14355 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
14356
14357 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14358 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14359 @ignore
14360 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14361 @kindex Epoch
14362 @kindex inspect
14363
14364 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14365 called the @code{epoch}
14366 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14367 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14368 each value is printed in its own window.
14369 @end ignore
14370
14371
14372 @node GDB/MI
14373 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
14374
14375 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
14376
14377 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
14378 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to @value{GDBN}. It is
14379 specifically intended to support the development of systems which use
14380 the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
14381
14382 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
14383 in the form of a reference manual.
14384
14385 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
14386 features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
14387
14388 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
14389
14390 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
14391 This chapter uses the following notation:
14392
14393 @itemize @bullet
14394 @item
14395 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
14396
14397 @item
14398 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
14399 it may or may not be given.
14400
14401 @item
14402 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14403 may repeat zero or more times.
14404
14405 @item
14406 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14407 may repeat one or more times.
14408
14409 @item
14410 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
14411 @end itemize
14412
14413 @ignore
14414 @heading Dependencies
14415 @end ignore
14416
14417 @heading Acknowledgments
14418
14419 In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
14420 Elena Zannoni.
14421
14422 @menu
14423 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
14424 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
14425 * GDB/MI Output Records::
14426 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
14427 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
14428 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
14429 * GDB/MI Program Control::
14430 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
14431 @ignore
14432 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
14433 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
14434 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
14435 @end ignore
14436 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
14437 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
14438 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
14439 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
14440 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
14441 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
14442 @end menu
14443
14444 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14445 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
14446 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
14447
14448 @menu
14449 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
14450 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
14451 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
14452 @end menu
14453
14454 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
14455 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
14456
14457 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
14458 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
14459 @table @code
14460 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
14461 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
14462
14463 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
14464 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
14465 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14466
14467 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
14468 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
14469 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
14470
14471 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
14472 "any sequence of digits"
14473
14474 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
14475 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
14476
14477 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
14478 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
14479
14480 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
14481 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
14482
14483 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
14484 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
14485 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
14486
14487 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
14488 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
14489
14490 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14491 @code{CR | CR-LF}
14492 @end table
14493
14494 @noindent
14495 Notes:
14496
14497 @itemize @bullet
14498 @item
14499 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
14500 output is described below.
14501
14502 @item
14503 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
14504 finishes.
14505
14506 @item
14507 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
14508 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
14509 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
14510 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
14511 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
14512 @end itemize
14513
14514 Pragmatics:
14515
14516 @itemize @bullet
14517 @item
14518 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
14519
14520 @item
14521 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
14522 @end itemize
14523
14524 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
14525 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
14526
14527 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
14528 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
14529 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
14530 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
14531 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
14532 terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
14533
14534 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
14535 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
14536 @var{token}.
14537
14538 @table @code
14539 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
14540 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
14541
14542 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
14543 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14544
14545 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
14546 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
14547
14548 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
14549 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
14550
14551 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
14552 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
14553
14554 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
14555 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
14556
14557 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
14558 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
14559
14560 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
14561 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14562
14563 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
14564 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
14565
14566 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
14567 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
14568 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
14569
14570 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
14571 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
14572
14573 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
14574 @code{ @var{string} }
14575
14576 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
14577 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
14578
14579 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
14580 @code{@var{c-string}}
14581
14582 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
14583 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
14584
14585 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
14586 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
14587 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
14588
14589 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
14590 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
14591
14592 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
14593 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
14594
14595 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
14596 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
14597
14598 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
14599 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
14600
14601 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14602 @code{CR | CR-LF}
14603
14604 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
14605 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
14606 @end table
14607
14608 @noindent
14609 Notes:
14610
14611 @itemize @bullet
14612 @item
14613 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
14614
14615 @item
14616 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
14617 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
14618 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
14619 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
14620
14621 @item
14622 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14623 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
14624 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
14625 prefixed by @samp{+}.
14626
14627 @item
14628 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14629 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
14630 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
14631 @samp{*}.
14632
14633 @item
14634 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14635 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
14636 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
14637 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
14638
14639 @item
14640 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14641 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
14642 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
14643 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
14644
14645 @item
14646 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14647 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
14648 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
14649
14650 @item
14651 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14652 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
14653 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
14654 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
14655
14656 @item
14657 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14658 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
14659 @var{values}.
14660
14661
14662 @end itemize
14663
14664 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
14665 details about the various output records.
14666
14667 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
14668 @subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
14669 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
14670
14671 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
14672 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
14673 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
14674 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
14675
14676 @subsubheading Target Stop
14677 @c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
14678 Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
14679
14680 @smallexample
14681 -> -stop
14682 <- (@value{GDBP})
14683 @end smallexample
14684
14685 @noindent
14686 and later:
14687
14688 @smallexample
14689 <- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14690 <- (@value{GDBP})
14691 @end smallexample
14692
14693 @subsubheading Simple CLI Command
14694
14695 Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
14696 @sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
14697
14698 @smallexample
14699 -> print 1+2
14700 <- &"print 1+2\n"
14701 <- ~"$1 = 3\n"
14702 <- ^done
14703 <- (@value{GDBP})
14704 @end smallexample
14705
14706 @subsubheading Command With Side Effects
14707
14708 @smallexample
14709 -> -symbol-file xyz.exe
14710 <- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14711 <- (@value{GDBP})
14712 @end smallexample
14713
14714 @subsubheading A Bad Command
14715
14716 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
14717
14718 @smallexample
14719 -> -rubbish
14720 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
14721 <- (@value{GDBP})
14722 @end smallexample
14723
14724 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14725 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
14726 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
14727
14728 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
14729 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
14730 To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
14731 accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
14732 commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
14733 respond.
14734
14735 This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
14736 clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
14737 is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
14738 behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
14739 an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
14740
14741 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14742 @node GDB/MI Output Records
14743 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
14744
14745 @menu
14746 * GDB/MI Result Records::
14747 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
14748 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
14749 @end menu
14750
14751 @node GDB/MI Result Records
14752 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
14753
14754 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14755 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
14756 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
14757 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
14758
14759 @table @code
14760 @findex ^done
14761 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
14762 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
14763 values.
14764
14765 @item "^running"
14766 @findex ^running
14767 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
14768 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
14769 running.
14770
14771 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
14772 @findex ^error
14773 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
14774 error message.
14775 @end table
14776
14777 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
14778 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
14779
14780 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
14781 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14782 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
14783 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
14784 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
14785
14786 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
14787 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
14788 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
14789 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
14790 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
14791
14792 @table @code
14793 @item "~" @var{string-output}
14794 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
14795 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
14796
14797 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
14798 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
14799 target.
14800
14801 @item "&" @var{string-output}
14802 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
14803 internals.
14804 @end table
14805
14806 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
14807 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
14808
14809 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14810 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
14811 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
14812 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
14813 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
14814 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
14815
14816 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
14817
14818 @table @code
14819 @item "*" "stop"
14820 @end table
14821
14822
14823 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14824 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
14825 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
14826
14827 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
14828 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
14829
14830 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
14831 readability. They don't appear in the real output.
14832 Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
14833 not yet implemented.
14834
14835 @subheading Motivation
14836
14837 The motivation for this collection of commands.
14838
14839 @subheading Introduction
14840
14841 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
14842
14843 @subheading Commands
14844
14845 For each command in the block, the following is described:
14846
14847 @subsubheading Synopsis
14848
14849 @smallexample
14850 -command @var{args}@dots{}
14851 @end smallexample
14852
14853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14854
14855 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14856
14857 @subsubheading Result
14858
14859 @subsubheading Out-of-band
14860
14861 @subsubheading Notes
14862
14863 @subsubheading Example
14864
14865
14866 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14867 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
14868 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
14869
14870 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
14871 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
14872 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
14873 breakpoints.
14874
14875 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
14876 @findex -break-after
14877
14878 @subsubheading Synopsis
14879
14880 @smallexample
14881 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
14882 @end smallexample
14883
14884 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
14885 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
14886 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
14887 @samp{-break-list} command below.
14888
14889 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14890
14891 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
14892
14893 @subsubheading Example
14894
14895 @smallexample
14896 (@value{GDBP})
14897 -break-insert main
14898 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
14899 (@value{GDBP})
14900 -break-after 1 3
14901 ~
14902 ^done
14903 (@value{GDBP})
14904 -break-list
14905 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14906 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14907 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14908 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14909 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14910 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14911 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14912 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14913 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
14914 ignore="3"@}]@}
14915 (@value{GDBP})
14916 @end smallexample
14917
14918 @ignore
14919 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
14920 @findex -break-catch
14921
14922 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
14923 @findex -break-commands
14924 @end ignore
14925
14926
14927 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
14928 @findex -break-condition
14929
14930 @subsubheading Synopsis
14931
14932 @smallexample
14933 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
14934 @end smallexample
14935
14936 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
14937 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
14938 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
14939 command below).
14940
14941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14942
14943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
14944
14945 @subsubheading Example
14946
14947 @smallexample
14948 (@value{GDBP})
14949 -break-condition 1 1
14950 ^done
14951 (@value{GDBP})
14952 -break-list
14953 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14954 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14955 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14956 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14957 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14958 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14959 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14960 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14961 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
14962 times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
14963 (@value{GDBP})
14964 @end smallexample
14965
14966 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
14967 @findex -break-delete
14968
14969 @subsubheading Synopsis
14970
14971 @smallexample
14972 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14973 @end smallexample
14974
14975 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
14976 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
14977
14978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14979
14980 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
14981
14982 @subsubheading Example
14983
14984 @smallexample
14985 (@value{GDBP})
14986 -break-delete 1
14987 ^done
14988 (@value{GDBP})
14989 -break-list
14990 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
14991 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14992 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14993 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14994 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14995 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14996 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14997 body=[]@}
14998 (@value{GDBP})
14999 @end smallexample
15000
15001 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
15002 @findex -break-disable
15003
15004 @subsubheading Synopsis
15005
15006 @smallexample
15007 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
15008 @end smallexample
15009
15010 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
15011 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
15012
15013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15014
15015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
15016
15017 @subsubheading Example
15018
15019 @smallexample
15020 (@value{GDBP})
15021 -break-disable 2
15022 ^done
15023 (@value{GDBP})
15024 -break-list
15025 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15026 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15027 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15028 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15029 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15030 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15031 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15032 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
15033 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
15034 (@value{GDBP})
15035 @end smallexample
15036
15037 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
15038 @findex -break-enable
15039
15040 @subsubheading Synopsis
15041
15042 @smallexample
15043 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
15044 @end smallexample
15045
15046 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
15047
15048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15049
15050 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
15051
15052 @subsubheading Example
15053
15054 @smallexample
15055 (@value{GDBP})
15056 -break-enable 2
15057 ^done
15058 (@value{GDBP})
15059 -break-list
15060 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15061 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15062 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15063 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15064 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15065 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15066 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15067 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15068 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
15069 (@value{GDBP})
15070 @end smallexample
15071
15072 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
15073 @findex -break-info
15074
15075 @subsubheading Synopsis
15076
15077 @smallexample
15078 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
15079 @end smallexample
15080
15081 @c REDUNDANT???
15082 Get information about a single breakpoint.
15083
15084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
15085
15086 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
15087
15088 @subsubheading Example
15089 N.A.
15090
15091 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
15092 @findex -break-insert
15093
15094 @subsubheading Synopsis
15095
15096 @smallexample
15097 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
15098 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
15099 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
15100 @end smallexample
15101
15102 @noindent
15103 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
15104
15105 @itemize @bullet
15106 @item function
15107 @c @item +offset
15108 @c @item -offset
15109 @c @item linenum
15110 @item filename:linenum
15111 @item filename:function
15112 @item *address
15113 @end itemize
15114
15115 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
15116
15117 @table @samp
15118 @item -t
15119 Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
15120 @item -h
15121 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
15122 @item -c @var{condition}
15123 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
15124 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
15125 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
15126 @item -r
15127 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
15128 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
15129 expresson.
15130 @end table
15131
15132 @subsubheading Result
15133
15134 The result is in the form:
15135
15136 @smallexample
15137 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
15138 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
15139 @end smallexample
15140
15141 @noindent
15142 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
15143 is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
15144 @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
15145 function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
15146
15147 Note: this format is open to change.
15148 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
15149
15150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15151
15152 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
15153 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
15154
15155 @subsubheading Example
15156
15157 @smallexample
15158 (@value{GDBP})
15159 -break-insert main
15160 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
15161 (@value{GDBP})
15162 -break-insert -t foo
15163 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15164 (@value{GDBP})
15165 -break-list
15166 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15167 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15168 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15169 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15170 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15171 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15172 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15173 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15174 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
15175 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
15176 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
15177 (@value{GDBP})
15178 -break-insert -r foo.*
15179 ~int foo(int, int);
15180 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15181 (@value{GDBP})
15182 @end smallexample
15183
15184 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
15185 @findex -break-list
15186
15187 @subsubheading Synopsis
15188
15189 @smallexample
15190 -break-list
15191 @end smallexample
15192
15193 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
15194
15195 @table @samp
15196 @item Number
15197 number of the breakpoint
15198 @item Type
15199 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
15200 @item Disposition
15201 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
15202 or @samp{nokeep}
15203 @item Enabled
15204 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
15205 @item Address
15206 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
15207 @item What
15208 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
15209 name, line number
15210 @item Times
15211 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
15212 @end table
15213
15214 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
15215 @code{body} field is an empty list.
15216
15217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15218
15219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
15220
15221 @subsubheading Example
15222
15223 @smallexample
15224 (@value{GDBP})
15225 -break-list
15226 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15227 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15228 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15229 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15230 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15231 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15232 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15233 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15234 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
15235 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15236 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
15237 (@value{GDBP})
15238 @end smallexample
15239
15240 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
15241
15242 @smallexample
15243 (@value{GDBP})
15244 -break-list
15245 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
15246 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15247 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15248 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15249 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15250 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15251 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15252 body=[]@}
15253 (@value{GDBP})
15254 @end smallexample
15255
15256 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
15257 @findex -break-watch
15258
15259 @subsubheading Synopsis
15260
15261 @smallexample
15262 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
15263 @end smallexample
15264
15265 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
15266 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
15267 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
15268 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
15269 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
15270 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
15271 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
15272 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
15273
15274 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
15275 breakpoints inserted.
15276
15277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15278
15279 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
15280 @samp{rwatch}.
15281
15282 @subsubheading Example
15283
15284 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
15285
15286 @smallexample
15287 (@value{GDBP})
15288 -break-watch x
15289 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
15290 (@value{GDBP})
15291 -exec-continue
15292 ^running
15293 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
15294 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
15295 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="5"@}
15296 (@value{GDBP})
15297 @end smallexample
15298
15299 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
15300 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
15301 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
15302
15303 @smallexample
15304 (@value{GDBP})
15305 -break-watch C
15306 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
15307 (@value{GDBP})
15308 -exec-continue
15309 ^running
15310 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
15311 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15312 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15313 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15314 (@value{GDBP})
15315 -exec-continue
15316 ^running
15317 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
15318 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15319 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15320 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15321 (@value{GDBP})
15322 @end smallexample
15323
15324 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
15325 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
15326 deleted.
15327
15328 @smallexample
15329 (@value{GDBP})
15330 -break-watch C
15331 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
15332 (@value{GDBP})
15333 -break-list
15334 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15335 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15336 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15337 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15338 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15339 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15340 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15341 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15342 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15343 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15344 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15345 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
15346 (@value{GDBP})
15347 -exec-continue
15348 ^running
15349 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
15350 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15351 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15352 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15353 (@value{GDBP})
15354 -break-list
15355 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15356 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15357 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15358 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15359 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15360 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15361 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15362 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15363 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15364 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15365 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15366 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
15367 (@value{GDBP})
15368 -exec-continue
15369 ^running
15370 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
15371 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15372 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15373 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15374 (@value{GDBP})
15375 -break-list
15376 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15377 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15378 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15379 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15380 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15381 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15382 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15383 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15384 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15385 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
15386 (@value{GDBP})
15387 @end smallexample
15388
15389 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15390 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
15391 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
15392
15393 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
15394 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
15395 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
15396 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
15397
15398 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
15399 @c @subheading -data-assign
15400 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
15401 @c @subsubheading GDB command
15402 @c set variable
15403 @c @subsubheading Example
15404 @c N.A.
15405
15406 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
15407 @findex -data-disassemble
15408
15409 @subsubheading Synopsis
15410
15411 @smallexample
15412 -data-disassemble
15413 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
15414 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
15415 -- @var{mode}
15416 @end smallexample
15417
15418 @noindent
15419 Where:
15420
15421 @table @samp
15422 @item @var{start-addr}
15423 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
15424 @item @var{end-addr}
15425 is the end address
15426 @item @var{filename}
15427 is the name of the file to disassemble
15428 @item @var{linenum}
15429 is the line number to disassemble around
15430 @item @var{lines}
15431 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
15432 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
15433 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
15434 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
15435 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
15436 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
15437 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
15438 are displayed.
15439 @item @var{mode}
15440 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
15441 disassembly).
15442 @end table
15443
15444 @subsubheading Result
15445
15446 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
15447
15448 @itemize @bullet
15449 @item Address
15450 @item Func-name
15451 @item Offset
15452 @item Instruction
15453 @end itemize
15454
15455 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
15456 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
15457
15458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15459
15460 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
15461
15462 @subsubheading Example
15463
15464 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
15465
15466 @smallexample
15467 (@value{GDBP})
15468 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
15469 ^done,
15470 asm_insns=[
15471 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15472 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15473 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15474 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15475 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
15476 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
15477 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
15478 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15479 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
15480 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
15481 (@value{GDBP})
15482 @end smallexample
15483
15484 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
15485 @code{main}.
15486
15487 @smallexample
15488 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
15489 ^done,asm_insns=[
15490 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15491 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15492 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15493 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15494 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15495 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15496 [@dots{}]
15497 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
15498 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
15499 (@value{GDBP})
15500 @end smallexample
15501
15502 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
15503
15504 @smallexample
15505 (@value{GDBP})
15506 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
15507 ^done,asm_insns=[
15508 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15509 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15510 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15511 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15512 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15513 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
15514 (@value{GDBP})
15515 @end smallexample
15516
15517 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
15518
15519 @smallexample
15520 (@value{GDBP})
15521 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
15522 ^done,asm_insns=[
15523 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
15524 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15525 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15526 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15527 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
15528 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
15529 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15530 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15531 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15532 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15533 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15534 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
15535 (@value{GDBP})
15536 @end smallexample
15537
15538
15539 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
15540 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
15541
15542 @subsubheading Synopsis
15543
15544 @smallexample
15545 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
15546 @end smallexample
15547
15548 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
15549 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
15550 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
15551
15552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15553
15554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
15555 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
15556 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
15557
15558 @subsubheading Example
15559
15560 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
15561 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
15562 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
15563 output.
15564
15565 @smallexample
15566 211-data-evaluate-expression A
15567 211^done,value="1"
15568 (@value{GDBP})
15569 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
15570 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
15571 (@value{GDBP})
15572 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
15573 411^done,value="4"
15574 (@value{GDBP})
15575 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
15576 511^done,value="4"
15577 (@value{GDBP})
15578 @end smallexample
15579
15580
15581 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
15582 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
15583
15584 @subsubheading Synopsis
15585
15586 @smallexample
15587 -data-list-changed-registers
15588 @end smallexample
15589
15590 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
15591
15592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15593
15594 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
15595 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
15596
15597 @subsubheading Example
15598
15599 On a PPC MBX board:
15600
15601 @smallexample
15602 (@value{GDBP})
15603 -exec-continue
15604 ^running
15605
15606 (@value{GDBP})
15607 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
15608 args=[],file="try.c",line="5"@}
15609 (@value{GDBP})
15610 -data-list-changed-registers
15611 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
15612 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
15613 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
15614 (@value{GDBP})
15615 @end smallexample
15616
15617
15618 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
15619 @findex -data-list-register-names
15620
15621 @subsubheading Synopsis
15622
15623 @smallexample
15624 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
15625 @end smallexample
15626
15627 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
15628 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
15629 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
15630 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
15631 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
15632 include empty register names.
15633
15634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15635
15636 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
15637 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
15638 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
15639
15640 @subsubheading Example
15641
15642 For the PPC MBX board:
15643 @smallexample
15644 (@value{GDBP})
15645 -data-list-register-names
15646 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
15647 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
15648 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
15649 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
15650 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
15651 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
15652 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
15653 (@value{GDBP})
15654 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
15655 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
15656 (@value{GDBP})
15657 @end smallexample
15658
15659 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
15660 @findex -data-list-register-values
15661
15662 @subsubheading Synopsis
15663
15664 @smallexample
15665 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
15666 @end smallexample
15667
15668 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
15669 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
15670 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
15671 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
15672
15673 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
15674
15675 @table @code
15676 @item x
15677 Hexadecimal
15678 @item o
15679 Octal
15680 @item t
15681 Binary
15682 @item d
15683 Decimal
15684 @item r
15685 Raw
15686 @item N
15687 Natural
15688 @end table
15689
15690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15691
15692 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
15693 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
15694
15695 @subsubheading Example
15696
15697 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
15698 don't appear in the actual output):
15699
15700 @smallexample
15701 (@value{GDBP})
15702 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
15703 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15704 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
15705 (@value{GDBP})
15706 -data-list-register-values x
15707 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
15708 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15709 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
15710 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
15711 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
15712 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
15713 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
15714 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
15715 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
15716 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15717 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
15718 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
15719 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
15720 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
15721 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
15722 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
15723 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
15724 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
15725 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
15726 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
15727 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
15728 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
15729 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
15730 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
15731 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
15732 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
15733 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
15734 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
15735 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
15736 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
15737 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
15738 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
15739 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15740 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
15741 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
15742 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
15743 (@value{GDBP})
15744 @end smallexample
15745
15746
15747 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
15748 @findex -data-read-memory
15749
15750 @subsubheading Synopsis
15751
15752 @smallexample
15753 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
15754 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
15755 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
15756 @end smallexample
15757
15758 @noindent
15759 where:
15760
15761 @table @samp
15762 @item @var{address}
15763 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
15764 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
15765 quoted using the C convention.
15766
15767 @item @var{word-format}
15768 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
15769 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
15770 ,Output formats}).
15771
15772 @item @var{word-size}
15773 The size of each memory word in bytes.
15774
15775 @item @var{nr-rows}
15776 The number of rows in the output table.
15777
15778 @item @var{nr-cols}
15779 The number of columns in the output table.
15780
15781 @item @var{aschar}
15782 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
15783 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
15784 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
15785 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
15786
15787 @item @var{byte-offset}
15788 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
15789 @end table
15790
15791 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
15792 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
15793 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
15794 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
15795 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
15796 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
15797 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
15798 @samp{addr}.
15799
15800 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
15801 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
15802 @samp{prev-page}.
15803
15804 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15805
15806 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
15807 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
15808
15809 @subsubheading Example
15810
15811 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
15812 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
15813 word. Display each word in hex.
15814
15815 @smallexample
15816 (@value{GDBP})
15817 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
15818 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
15819 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
15820 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
15821 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
15822 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
15823 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
15824 (@value{GDBP})
15825 @end smallexample
15826
15827 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
15828 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
15829
15830 @smallexample
15831 (@value{GDBP})
15832 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
15833 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
15834 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
15835 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
15836 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
15837 (@value{GDBP})
15838 @end smallexample
15839
15840 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
15841 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
15842 used as the non-printable character.
15843
15844 @smallexample
15845 (@value{GDBP})
15846 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
15847 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
15848 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
15849 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
15850 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15851 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15852 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15853 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15854 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
15855 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
15856 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
15857 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
15858 (@value{GDBP})
15859 @end smallexample
15860
15861 @subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
15862 @findex -display-delete
15863
15864 @subsubheading Synopsis
15865
15866 @smallexample
15867 -display-delete @var{number}
15868 @end smallexample
15869
15870 Delete the display @var{number}.
15871
15872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15873
15874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
15875
15876 @subsubheading Example
15877 N.A.
15878
15879
15880 @subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
15881 @findex -display-disable
15882
15883 @subsubheading Synopsis
15884
15885 @smallexample
15886 -display-disable @var{number}
15887 @end smallexample
15888
15889 Disable display @var{number}.
15890
15891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15892
15893 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
15894
15895 @subsubheading Example
15896 N.A.
15897
15898
15899 @subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
15900 @findex -display-enable
15901
15902 @subsubheading Synopsis
15903
15904 @smallexample
15905 -display-enable @var{number}
15906 @end smallexample
15907
15908 Enable display @var{number}.
15909
15910 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15911
15912 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
15913
15914 @subsubheading Example
15915 N.A.
15916
15917
15918 @subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
15919 @findex -display-insert
15920
15921 @subsubheading Synopsis
15922
15923 @smallexample
15924 -display-insert @var{expression}
15925 @end smallexample
15926
15927 Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
15928
15929 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15930
15931 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
15932
15933 @subsubheading Example
15934 N.A.
15935
15936
15937 @subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
15938 @findex -display-list
15939
15940 @subsubheading Synopsis
15941
15942 @smallexample
15943 -display-list
15944 @end smallexample
15945
15946 List the displays. Do not show the current values.
15947
15948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15949
15950 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
15951
15952 @subsubheading Example
15953 N.A.
15954
15955
15956 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
15957 @findex -environment-cd
15958
15959 @subsubheading Synopsis
15960
15961 @smallexample
15962 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
15963 @end smallexample
15964
15965 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
15966
15967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15968
15969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
15970
15971 @subsubheading Example
15972
15973 @smallexample
15974 (@value{GDBP})
15975 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15976 ^done
15977 (@value{GDBP})
15978 @end smallexample
15979
15980
15981 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
15982 @findex -environment-directory
15983
15984 @subsubheading Synopsis
15985
15986 @smallexample
15987 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15988 @end smallexample
15989
15990 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
15991 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
15992 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
15993 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15994 occurs as normal.
15995 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15996 multiple directories in a single command
15997 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15998 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15999 If blanks are needed as
16000 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
16001 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
16002 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
16003 character must not be used
16004 in any directory name.
16005 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
16006
16007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16008
16009 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
16010
16011 @subsubheading Example
16012
16013 @smallexample
16014 (@value{GDBP})
16015 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
16016 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
16017 (@value{GDBP})
16018 -environment-directory ""
16019 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
16020 (@value{GDBP})
16021 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
16022 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
16023 (@value{GDBP})
16024 -environment-directory -r
16025 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
16026 (@value{GDBP})
16027 @end smallexample
16028
16029
16030 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
16031 @findex -environment-path
16032
16033 @subsubheading Synopsis
16034
16035 @smallexample
16036 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
16037 @end smallexample
16038
16039 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
16040 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
16041 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
16042 supplied in addition to the
16043 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
16044 occurs as normal.
16045 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
16046 multiple directories in a single command
16047 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
16048 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
16049 If blanks are needed as
16050 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
16051 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
16052 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
16053 character must not be used
16054 in any directory name.
16055 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
16056
16057
16058 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16059
16060 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
16061
16062 @subsubheading Example
16063
16064 @smallexample
16065 (@value{GDBP})
16066 -environment-path
16067 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
16068 (@value{GDBP})
16069 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
16070 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
16071 (@value{GDBP})
16072 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
16073 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
16074 (@value{GDBP})
16075 @end smallexample
16076
16077
16078 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
16079 @findex -environment-pwd
16080
16081 @subsubheading Synopsis
16082
16083 @smallexample
16084 -environment-pwd
16085 @end smallexample
16086
16087 Show the current working directory.
16088
16089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16090
16091 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
16092
16093 @subsubheading Example
16094
16095 @smallexample
16096 (@value{GDBP})
16097 -environment-pwd
16098 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
16099 (@value{GDBP})
16100 @end smallexample
16101
16102 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16103 @node GDB/MI Program Control
16104 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
16105
16106 @subsubheading Program termination
16107
16108 As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
16109 it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
16110 include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
16111
16112 @subsubheading Examples
16113
16114 @noindent
16115 Program exited normally:
16116
16117 @smallexample
16118 (@value{GDBP})
16119 -exec-run
16120 ^running
16121 (@value{GDBP})
16122 x = 55
16123 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
16124 (@value{GDBP})
16125 @end smallexample
16126
16127 @noindent
16128 Program exited exceptionally:
16129
16130 @smallexample
16131 (@value{GDBP})
16132 -exec-run
16133 ^running
16134 (@value{GDBP})
16135 x = 55
16136 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
16137 (@value{GDBP})
16138 @end smallexample
16139
16140 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
16141 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
16142
16143 @smallexample
16144 (@value{GDBP})
16145 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
16146 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
16147 @end smallexample
16148
16149
16150 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
16151 @findex -exec-abort
16152
16153 @subsubheading Synopsis
16154
16155 @smallexample
16156 -exec-abort
16157 @end smallexample
16158
16159 Kill the inferior running program.
16160
16161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16162
16163 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
16164
16165 @subsubheading Example
16166 N.A.
16167
16168
16169 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
16170 @findex -exec-arguments
16171
16172 @subsubheading Synopsis
16173
16174 @smallexample
16175 -exec-arguments @var{args}
16176 @end smallexample
16177
16178 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
16179 @samp{-exec-run}.
16180
16181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16182
16183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
16184
16185 @subsubheading Example
16186
16187 @c FIXME!
16188 Don't have one around.
16189
16190
16191 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
16192 @findex -exec-continue
16193
16194 @subsubheading Synopsis
16195
16196 @smallexample
16197 -exec-continue
16198 @end smallexample
16199
16200 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16201 until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
16202
16203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16204
16205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
16206
16207 @subsubheading Example
16208
16209 @smallexample
16210 -exec-continue
16211 ^running
16212 (@value{GDBP})
16213 @@Hello world
16214 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
16215 file="hello.c",line="13"@}
16216 (@value{GDBP})
16217 @end smallexample
16218
16219
16220 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
16221 @findex -exec-finish
16222
16223 @subsubheading Synopsis
16224
16225 @smallexample
16226 -exec-finish
16227 @end smallexample
16228
16229 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16230 until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
16231 the function.
16232
16233 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16234
16235 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
16236
16237 @subsubheading Example
16238
16239 Function returning @code{void}.
16240
16241 @smallexample
16242 -exec-finish
16243 ^running
16244 (@value{GDBP})
16245 @@hello from foo
16246 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16247 file="hello.c",line="7"@}
16248 (@value{GDBP})
16249 @end smallexample
16250
16251 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
16252 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
16253 value itself.
16254
16255 @smallexample
16256 -exec-finish
16257 ^running
16258 (@value{GDBP})
16259 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
16260 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
16261 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16262 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
16263 (@value{GDBP})
16264 @end smallexample
16265
16266
16267 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
16268 @findex -exec-interrupt
16269
16270 @subsubheading Synopsis
16271
16272 @smallexample
16273 -exec-interrupt
16274 @end smallexample
16275
16276 Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
16277 Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
16278 execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
16279 itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
16280 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
16281
16282 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16283
16284 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
16285
16286 @subsubheading Example
16287
16288 @smallexample
16289 (@value{GDBP})
16290 111-exec-continue
16291 111^running
16292
16293 (@value{GDBP})
16294 222-exec-interrupt
16295 222^done
16296 (@value{GDBP})
16297 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
16298 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="13"@}
16299 (@value{GDBP})
16300
16301 (@value{GDBP})
16302 -exec-interrupt
16303 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
16304 (@value{GDBP})
16305 @end smallexample
16306
16307
16308 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
16309 @findex -exec-next
16310
16311 @subsubheading Synopsis
16312
16313 @smallexample
16314 -exec-next
16315 @end smallexample
16316
16317 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16318 when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
16319
16320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16321
16322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
16323
16324 @subsubheading Example
16325
16326 @smallexample
16327 -exec-next
16328 ^running
16329 (@value{GDBP})
16330 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
16331 (@value{GDBP})
16332 @end smallexample
16333
16334
16335 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
16336 @findex -exec-next-instruction
16337
16338 @subsubheading Synopsis
16339
16340 @smallexample
16341 -exec-next-instruction
16342 @end smallexample
16343
16344 Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
16345 instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
16346 the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
16347 address will be printed as well.
16348
16349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16350
16351 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
16352
16353 @subsubheading Example
16354
16355 @smallexample
16356 (@value{GDBP})
16357 -exec-next-instruction
16358 ^running
16359
16360 (@value{GDBP})
16361 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16362 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
16363 (@value{GDBP})
16364 @end smallexample
16365
16366
16367 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
16368 @findex -exec-return
16369
16370 @subsubheading Synopsis
16371
16372 @smallexample
16373 -exec-return
16374 @end smallexample
16375
16376 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
16377 Displays the new current frame.
16378
16379 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16380
16381 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
16382
16383 @subsubheading Example
16384
16385 @smallexample
16386 (@value{GDBP})
16387 200-break-insert callee4
16388 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
16389 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16390 (@value{GDBP})
16391 000-exec-run
16392 000^running
16393 (@value{GDBP})
16394 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16395 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
16396 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16397 (@value{GDBP})
16398 205-break-delete
16399 205^done
16400 (@value{GDBP})
16401 111-exec-return
16402 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
16403 args=[@{name="strarg",
16404 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
16405 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
16406 (@value{GDBP})
16407 @end smallexample
16408
16409
16410 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
16411 @findex -exec-run
16412
16413 @subsubheading Synopsis
16414
16415 @smallexample
16416 -exec-run
16417 @end smallexample
16418
16419 Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
16420 beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
16421 encountered or the program exits.
16422
16423 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16424
16425 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
16426
16427 @subsubheading Example
16428
16429 @smallexample
16430 (@value{GDBP})
16431 -break-insert main
16432 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16433 (@value{GDBP})
16434 -exec-run
16435 ^running
16436 (@value{GDBP})
16437 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16438 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16439 (@value{GDBP})
16440 @end smallexample
16441
16442
16443 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
16444 @findex -exec-show-arguments
16445
16446 @subsubheading Synopsis
16447
16448 @smallexample
16449 -exec-show-arguments
16450 @end smallexample
16451
16452 Print the arguments of the program.
16453
16454 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16455
16456 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
16457
16458 @subsubheading Example
16459 N.A.
16460
16461 @c @subheading -exec-signal
16462
16463 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
16464 @findex -exec-step
16465
16466 @subsubheading Synopsis
16467
16468 @smallexample
16469 -exec-step
16470 @end smallexample
16471
16472 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16473 when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
16474 source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
16475 instruction of the called function.
16476
16477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16478
16479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
16480
16481 @subsubheading Example
16482
16483 Stepping into a function:
16484
16485 @smallexample
16486 -exec-step
16487 ^running
16488 (@value{GDBP})
16489 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16490 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
16491 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
16492 (@value{GDBP})
16493 @end smallexample
16494
16495 Regular stepping:
16496
16497 @smallexample
16498 -exec-step
16499 ^running
16500 (@value{GDBP})
16501 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
16502 (@value{GDBP})
16503 @end smallexample
16504
16505
16506 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
16507 @findex -exec-step-instruction
16508
16509 @subsubheading Synopsis
16510
16511 @smallexample
16512 -exec-step-instruction
16513 @end smallexample
16514
16515 Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
16516 instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
16517 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
16518 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
16519 well.
16520
16521 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16522
16523 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
16524
16525 @subsubheading Example
16526
16527 @smallexample
16528 (@value{GDBP})
16529 -exec-step-instruction
16530 ^running
16531
16532 (@value{GDBP})
16533 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16534 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16535 (@value{GDBP})
16536 -exec-step-instruction
16537 ^running
16538
16539 (@value{GDBP})
16540 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16541 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16542 (@value{GDBP})
16543 @end smallexample
16544
16545
16546 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
16547 @findex -exec-until
16548
16549 @subsubheading Synopsis
16550
16551 @smallexample
16552 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
16553 @end smallexample
16554
16555 Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
16556 specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
16557 executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
16558 The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
16559
16560 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16561
16562 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
16563
16564 @subsubheading Example
16565
16566 @smallexample
16567 (@value{GDBP})
16568 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
16569 ^running
16570 (@value{GDBP})
16571 x = 55
16572 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16573 file="recursive2.c",line="6"@}
16574 (@value{GDBP})
16575 @end smallexample
16576
16577 @ignore
16578 @subheading -file-clear
16579 Is this going away????
16580 @end ignore
16581
16582
16583 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
16584 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
16585
16586 @subsubheading Synopsis
16587
16588 @smallexample
16589 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
16590 @end smallexample
16591
16592 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
16593 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
16594 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
16595 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
16596 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
16597 notification.
16598
16599 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16600
16601 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
16602
16603 @subsubheading Example
16604
16605 @smallexample
16606 (@value{GDBP})
16607 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16608 ^done
16609 (@value{GDBP})
16610 @end smallexample
16611
16612
16613 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
16614 @findex -file-exec-file
16615
16616 @subsubheading Synopsis
16617
16618 @smallexample
16619 -file-exec-file @var{file}
16620 @end smallexample
16621
16622 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
16623 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
16624 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
16625 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
16626 notification.
16627
16628 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16629
16630 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
16631
16632 @subsubheading Example
16633
16634 @smallexample
16635 (@value{GDBP})
16636 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16637 ^done
16638 (@value{GDBP})
16639 @end smallexample
16640
16641
16642 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
16643 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
16644
16645 @subsubheading Synopsis
16646
16647 @smallexample
16648 -file-list-exec-sections
16649 @end smallexample
16650
16651 List the sections of the current executable file.
16652
16653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16654
16655 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
16656 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
16657 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
16658
16659 @subsubheading Example
16660 N.A.
16661
16662
16663 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
16664 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
16665
16666 @subsubheading Synopsis
16667
16668 @smallexample
16669 -file-list-exec-source-file
16670 @end smallexample
16671
16672 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
16673 to the current source file for the current executable.
16674
16675 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16676
16677 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16678
16679 @subsubheading Example
16680
16681 @smallexample
16682 (@value{GDBP})
16683 123-file-list-exec-source-file
16684 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
16685 (@value{GDBP})
16686 @end smallexample
16687
16688
16689 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
16690 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
16691
16692 @subsubheading Synopsis
16693
16694 @smallexample
16695 -file-list-exec-source-files
16696 @end smallexample
16697
16698 List the source files for the current executable.
16699
16700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16701
16702 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16703 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
16704
16705 @subsubheading Example
16706 N.A.
16707
16708
16709 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
16710 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
16711
16712 @subsubheading Synopsis
16713
16714 @smallexample
16715 -file-list-shared-libraries
16716 @end smallexample
16717
16718 List the shared libraries in the program.
16719
16720 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16721
16722 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
16723
16724 @subsubheading Example
16725 N.A.
16726
16727
16728 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
16729 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
16730
16731 @subsubheading Synopsis
16732
16733 @smallexample
16734 -file-list-symbol-files
16735 @end smallexample
16736
16737 List symbol files.
16738
16739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16740
16741 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
16742
16743 @subsubheading Example
16744 N.A.
16745
16746
16747 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
16748 @findex -file-symbol-file
16749
16750 @subsubheading Synopsis
16751
16752 @smallexample
16753 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
16754 @end smallexample
16755
16756 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
16757 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
16758 produced, except for a completion notification.
16759
16760 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16761
16762 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
16763
16764 @subsubheading Example
16765
16766 @smallexample
16767 (@value{GDBP})
16768 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16769 ^done
16770 (@value{GDBP})
16771 @end smallexample
16772
16773 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16774 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
16775 @section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
16776
16777 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
16778
16779 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
16780 @findex -gdb-exit
16781
16782 @subsubheading Synopsis
16783
16784 @smallexample
16785 -gdb-exit
16786 @end smallexample
16787
16788 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
16789
16790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16791
16792 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
16793
16794 @subsubheading Example
16795
16796 @smallexample
16797 (@value{GDBP})
16798 -gdb-exit
16799 @end smallexample
16800
16801 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
16802 @findex -gdb-set
16803
16804 @subsubheading Synopsis
16805
16806 @smallexample
16807 -gdb-set
16808 @end smallexample
16809
16810 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
16811 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
16812
16813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16814
16815 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
16816
16817 @subsubheading Example
16818
16819 @smallexample
16820 (@value{GDBP})
16821 -gdb-set $foo=3
16822 ^done
16823 (@value{GDBP})
16824 @end smallexample
16825
16826
16827 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
16828 @findex -gdb-show
16829
16830 @subsubheading Synopsis
16831
16832 @smallexample
16833 -gdb-show
16834 @end smallexample
16835
16836 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
16837
16838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16839
16840 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
16841
16842 @subsubheading Example
16843
16844 @smallexample
16845 (@value{GDBP})
16846 -gdb-show annotate
16847 ^done,value="0"
16848 (@value{GDBP})
16849 @end smallexample
16850
16851 @c @subheading -gdb-source
16852
16853
16854 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
16855 @findex -gdb-version
16856
16857 @subsubheading Synopsis
16858
16859 @smallexample
16860 -gdb-version
16861 @end smallexample
16862
16863 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
16864
16865 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16866
16867 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
16868 information when you start an interactive session.
16869
16870 @subsubheading Example
16871
16872 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
16873 @c box in TeX.
16874 @smallexample
16875 (@value{GDBP})
16876 -gdb-version
16877 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
16878 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
16879 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
16880 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
16881 ~ certain conditions.
16882 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
16883 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
16884 ~ details.
16885 ~This GDB was configured as
16886 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
16887 ^done
16888 (@value{GDBP})
16889 @end smallexample
16890
16891 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
16892 @findex -interpreter-exec
16893
16894 @subheading Synopsis
16895
16896 @smallexample
16897 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
16898 @end smallexample
16899
16900 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
16901
16902 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
16903
16904 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
16905
16906 @subheading Example
16907
16908 @smallexample
16909 (@value{GDBP})
16910 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
16911 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
16912 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
16913 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
16914 ^done
16915 (@value{GDBP})
16916 @end smallexample
16917
16918 @ignore
16919 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16920 @node GDB/MI Kod Commands
16921 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
16922
16923 The Kod commands are not implemented.
16924
16925 @c @subheading -kod-info
16926
16927 @c @subheading -kod-list
16928
16929 @c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
16930
16931 @c @subheading -kod-show
16932
16933 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16934 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
16935 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
16936
16937 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
16938
16939 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
16940
16941 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
16942
16943 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
16944
16945 @c @subheading -overlay-map
16946
16947 @c @subheading -overlay-off
16948
16949 @c @subheading -overlay-on
16950
16951 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
16952
16953 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16954 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
16955 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
16956
16957 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
16958
16959 @c @subheading -signal-handle
16960
16961 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
16962
16963 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
16964 @end ignore
16965
16966
16967 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16968 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
16969 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
16970
16971
16972 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
16973 @findex -stack-info-frame
16974
16975 @subsubheading Synopsis
16976
16977 @smallexample
16978 -stack-info-frame
16979 @end smallexample
16980
16981 Get info on the current frame.
16982
16983 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16984
16985 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
16986 (without arguments).
16987
16988 @subsubheading Example
16989 N.A.
16990
16991 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
16992 @findex -stack-info-depth
16993
16994 @subsubheading Synopsis
16995
16996 @smallexample
16997 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
16998 @end smallexample
16999
17000 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
17001 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
17002
17003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17004
17005 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17006
17007 @subsubheading Example
17008
17009 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
17010
17011 @smallexample
17012 (@value{GDBP})
17013 -stack-info-depth
17014 ^done,depth="12"
17015 (@value{GDBP})
17016 -stack-info-depth 4
17017 ^done,depth="4"
17018 (@value{GDBP})
17019 -stack-info-depth 12
17020 ^done,depth="12"
17021 (@value{GDBP})
17022 -stack-info-depth 11
17023 ^done,depth="11"
17024 (@value{GDBP})
17025 -stack-info-depth 13
17026 ^done,depth="12"
17027 (@value{GDBP})
17028 @end smallexample
17029
17030 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
17031 @findex -stack-list-arguments
17032
17033 @subsubheading Synopsis
17034
17035 @smallexample
17036 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
17037 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
17038 @end smallexample
17039
17040 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
17041 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
17042 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
17043 stack.
17044
17045 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
17046 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
17047 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
17048
17049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17050
17051 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
17052 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
17053 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
17054
17055 @subsubheading Example
17056
17057 @smallexample
17058 (@value{GDBP})
17059 -stack-list-frames
17060 ^done,
17061 stack=[
17062 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
17063 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
17064 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
17065 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
17066 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
17067 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
17068 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
17069 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
17070 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
17071 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
17072 (@value{GDBP})
17073 -stack-list-arguments 0
17074 ^done,
17075 stack-args=[
17076 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
17077 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
17078 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
17079 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
17080 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
17081 (@value{GDBP})
17082 -stack-list-arguments 1
17083 ^done,
17084 stack-args=[
17085 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
17086 frame=@{level="1",
17087 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
17088 frame=@{level="2",args=[
17089 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17090 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
17091 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
17092 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17093 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
17094 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
17095 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
17096 (@value{GDBP})
17097 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
17098 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
17099 (@value{GDBP})
17100 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
17101 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
17102 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17103 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
17104 (@value{GDBP})
17105 @end smallexample
17106
17107 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
17108
17109
17110 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
17111 @findex -stack-list-frames
17112
17113 @subsubheading Synopsis
17114
17115 @smallexample
17116 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
17117 @end smallexample
17118
17119 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
17120 following info:
17121
17122 @table @samp
17123 @item @var{level}
17124 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
17125 @item @var{addr}
17126 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
17127 @item @var{func}
17128 Function name.
17129 @item @var{file}
17130 File name of the source file where the function lives.
17131 @item @var{line}
17132 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
17133 @end table
17134
17135 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
17136 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
17137 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
17138 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
17139
17140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17141
17142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
17143
17144 @subsubheading Example
17145
17146 Full stack backtrace:
17147
17148 @smallexample
17149 (@value{GDBP})
17150 -stack-list-frames
17151 ^done,stack=
17152 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
17153 file="recursive2.c",line="11"@},
17154 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17155 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17156 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17157 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17158 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17159 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17160 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17161 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17162 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17163 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17164 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17165 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17166 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17167 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17168 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17169 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17170 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17171 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17172 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17173 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17174 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
17175 file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
17176 (@value{GDBP})
17177 @end smallexample
17178
17179 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
17180
17181 @smallexample
17182 (@value{GDBP})
17183 -stack-list-frames 3 5
17184 ^done,stack=
17185 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17186 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17187 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17188 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17189 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17190 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17191 (@value{GDBP})
17192 @end smallexample
17193
17194 Show a single frame:
17195
17196 @smallexample
17197 (@value{GDBP})
17198 -stack-list-frames 3 3
17199 ^done,stack=
17200 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17201 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17202 (@value{GDBP})
17203 @end smallexample
17204
17205
17206 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
17207 @findex -stack-list-locals
17208
17209 @subsubheading Synopsis
17210
17211 @smallexample
17212 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
17213 @end smallexample
17214
17215 Display the local variable names for the current frame. With an
17216 argument of 0 or @code{--no-values}, prints only the names of the variables.
17217 With argument of 1 or @code{--all-values}, prints also their values. With
17218 argument of 2 or @code{--simple-values}, prints the name, type and value for
17219 simple data types and the name and type for arrays, structures and
17220 unions. In this last case, the idea is that the user can see the
17221 value of simple data types immediately and he can create variable
17222 objects for other data types if he wishes to explore their values in
17223 more detail.
17224
17225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17226
17227 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
17228
17229 @subsubheading Example
17230
17231 @smallexample
17232 (@value{GDBP})
17233 -stack-list-locals 0
17234 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
17235 (@value{GDBP})
17236 -stack-list-locals --all-values
17237 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
17238 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
17239 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
17240 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
17241 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
17242 (@value{GDBP})
17243 @end smallexample
17244
17245
17246 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
17247 @findex -stack-select-frame
17248
17249 @subsubheading Synopsis
17250
17251 @smallexample
17252 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
17253 @end smallexample
17254
17255 Change the current frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
17256 the stack.
17257
17258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17259
17260 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
17261 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
17262
17263 @subsubheading Example
17264
17265 @smallexample
17266 (@value{GDBP})
17267 -stack-select-frame 2
17268 ^done
17269 (@value{GDBP})
17270 @end smallexample
17271
17272 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17273 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
17274 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
17275
17276
17277 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
17278 @findex -symbol-info-address
17279
17280 @subsubheading Synopsis
17281
17282 @smallexample
17283 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
17284 @end smallexample
17285
17286 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
17287
17288 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17289
17290 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
17291
17292 @subsubheading Example
17293 N.A.
17294
17295
17296 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
17297 @findex -symbol-info-file
17298
17299 @subsubheading Synopsis
17300
17301 @smallexample
17302 -symbol-info-file
17303 @end smallexample
17304
17305 Show the file for the symbol.
17306
17307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17308
17309 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
17310 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
17311
17312 @subsubheading Example
17313 N.A.
17314
17315
17316 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
17317 @findex -symbol-info-function
17318
17319 @subsubheading Synopsis
17320
17321 @smallexample
17322 -symbol-info-function
17323 @end smallexample
17324
17325 Show which function the symbol lives in.
17326
17327 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17328
17329 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
17330
17331 @subsubheading Example
17332 N.A.
17333
17334
17335 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
17336 @findex -symbol-info-line
17337
17338 @subsubheading Synopsis
17339
17340 @smallexample
17341 -symbol-info-line
17342 @end smallexample
17343
17344 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
17345
17346 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17347
17348 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
17349 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
17350
17351 @subsubheading Example
17352 N.A.
17353
17354
17355 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
17356 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
17357
17358 @subsubheading Synopsis
17359
17360 @smallexample
17361 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
17362 @end smallexample
17363
17364 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
17365
17366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17367
17368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
17369
17370 @subsubheading Example
17371 N.A.
17372
17373
17374 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
17375 @findex -symbol-list-functions
17376
17377 @subsubheading Synopsis
17378
17379 @smallexample
17380 -symbol-list-functions
17381 @end smallexample
17382
17383 List the functions in the executable.
17384
17385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17386
17387 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
17388 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17389
17390 @subsubheading Example
17391 N.A.
17392
17393
17394 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
17395 @findex -symbol-list-lines
17396
17397 @subsubheading Synopsis
17398
17399 @smallexample
17400 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
17401 @end smallexample
17402
17403 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
17404 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
17405 ascending PC order.
17406
17407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17408
17409 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
17410
17411 @subsubheading Example
17412 @smallexample
17413 (@value{GDBP})
17414 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
17415 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
17416 (@value{GDBP})
17417 @end smallexample
17418
17419
17420 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
17421 @findex -symbol-list-types
17422
17423 @subsubheading Synopsis
17424
17425 @smallexample
17426 -symbol-list-types
17427 @end smallexample
17428
17429 List all the type names.
17430
17431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17432
17433 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
17434 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17435
17436 @subsubheading Example
17437 N.A.
17438
17439
17440 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
17441 @findex -symbol-list-variables
17442
17443 @subsubheading Synopsis
17444
17445 @smallexample
17446 -symbol-list-variables
17447 @end smallexample
17448
17449 List all the global and static variable names.
17450
17451 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17452
17453 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17454
17455 @subsubheading Example
17456 N.A.
17457
17458
17459 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
17460 @findex -symbol-locate
17461
17462 @subsubheading Synopsis
17463
17464 @smallexample
17465 -symbol-locate
17466 @end smallexample
17467
17468 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17469
17470 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
17471
17472 @subsubheading Example
17473 N.A.
17474
17475
17476 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
17477 @findex -symbol-type
17478
17479 @subsubheading Synopsis
17480
17481 @smallexample
17482 -symbol-type @var{variable}
17483 @end smallexample
17484
17485 Show type of @var{variable}.
17486
17487 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17488
17489 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
17490 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
17491
17492 @subsubheading Example
17493 N.A.
17494
17495
17496 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17497 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
17498 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
17499
17500
17501 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
17502 @findex -target-attach
17503
17504 @subsubheading Synopsis
17505
17506 @smallexample
17507 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
17508 @end smallexample
17509
17510 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
17511
17512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17513
17514 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
17515
17516 @subsubheading Example
17517 N.A.
17518
17519
17520 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
17521 @findex -target-compare-sections
17522
17523 @subsubheading Synopsis
17524
17525 @smallexample
17526 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
17527 @end smallexample
17528
17529 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
17530 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
17531
17532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17533
17534 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
17535
17536 @subsubheading Example
17537 N.A.
17538
17539
17540 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
17541 @findex -target-detach
17542
17543 @subsubheading Synopsis
17544
17545 @smallexample
17546 -target-detach
17547 @end smallexample
17548
17549 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17550
17551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17552
17553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
17554
17555 @subsubheading Example
17556
17557 @smallexample
17558 (@value{GDBP})
17559 -target-detach
17560 ^done
17561 (@value{GDBP})
17562 @end smallexample
17563
17564
17565 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
17566 @findex -target-disconnect
17567
17568 @subsubheading Synopsis
17569
17570 @example
17571 -target-disconnect
17572 @end example
17573
17574 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17575
17576 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17577
17578 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
17579
17580 @subsubheading Example
17581
17582 @smallexample
17583 (@value{GDBP})
17584 -target-disconnect
17585 ^done
17586 (@value{GDBP})
17587 @end smallexample
17588
17589
17590 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
17591 @findex -target-download
17592
17593 @subsubheading Synopsis
17594
17595 @smallexample
17596 -target-download
17597 @end smallexample
17598
17599 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
17600 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
17601
17602 @table @samp
17603 @item section
17604 The name of the section.
17605 @item section-sent
17606 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
17607 @item section-size
17608 The size of the section.
17609 @item total-sent
17610 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
17611 @item total-size
17612 The size of the overall executable to download.
17613 @end table
17614
17615 @noindent
17616 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
17617 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
17618
17619 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
17620 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
17621
17622 @table @samp
17623 @item section
17624 The name of the section.
17625 @item section-size
17626 The size of the section.
17627 @item total-size
17628 The size of the overall executable to download.
17629 @end table
17630
17631 @noindent
17632 At the end, a summary is printed.
17633
17634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17635
17636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
17637
17638 @subsubheading Example
17639
17640 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
17641 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
17642
17643 @smallexample
17644 (@value{GDBP})
17645 -target-download
17646 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
17647 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
17648 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
17649 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
17650 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
17651 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
17652 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
17653 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
17654 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
17655 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
17656 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
17657 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
17658 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
17659 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
17660 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
17661 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
17662 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
17663 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
17664 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
17665 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
17666 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
17667 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
17668 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
17669 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
17670 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
17671 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
17672 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
17673 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17674 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17675 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
17676 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
17677 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
17678 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
17679 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
17680 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
17681 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
17682 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
17683 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
17684 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
17685 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
17686 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
17687 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
17688 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
17689 write-rate="429"
17690 (@value{GDBP})
17691 @end smallexample
17692
17693
17694 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
17695 @findex -target-exec-status
17696
17697 @subsubheading Synopsis
17698
17699 @smallexample
17700 -target-exec-status
17701 @end smallexample
17702
17703 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
17704 not, for instance).
17705
17706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17707
17708 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17709
17710 @subsubheading Example
17711 N.A.
17712
17713
17714 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
17715 @findex -target-list-available-targets
17716
17717 @subsubheading Synopsis
17718
17719 @smallexample
17720 -target-list-available-targets
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 List the possible targets to connect to.
17724
17725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17726
17727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
17728
17729 @subsubheading Example
17730 N.A.
17731
17732
17733 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
17734 @findex -target-list-current-targets
17735
17736 @subsubheading Synopsis
17737
17738 @smallexample
17739 -target-list-current-targets
17740 @end smallexample
17741
17742 Describe the current target.
17743
17744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17745
17746 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
17747 other things).
17748
17749 @subsubheading Example
17750 N.A.
17751
17752
17753 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
17754 @findex -target-list-parameters
17755
17756 @subsubheading Synopsis
17757
17758 @smallexample
17759 -target-list-parameters
17760 @end smallexample
17761
17762 @c ????
17763
17764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17765
17766 No equivalent.
17767
17768 @subsubheading Example
17769 N.A.
17770
17771
17772 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
17773 @findex -target-select
17774
17775 @subsubheading Synopsis
17776
17777 @smallexample
17778 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
17779 @end smallexample
17780
17781 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
17782
17783 @table @samp
17784 @item @var{type}
17785 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
17786 @item @var{parameters}
17787 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
17788 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
17789 @end table
17790
17791 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
17792 which the target program is, in the following form:
17793
17794 @smallexample
17795 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
17796 args=[@var{arg list}]
17797 @end smallexample
17798
17799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17800
17801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
17802
17803 @subsubheading Example
17804
17805 @smallexample
17806 (@value{GDBP})
17807 -target-select async /dev/ttya
17808 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
17809 (@value{GDBP})
17810 @end smallexample
17811
17812 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17813 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
17814 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
17815
17816
17817 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
17818 @findex -thread-info
17819
17820 @subsubheading Synopsis
17821
17822 @smallexample
17823 -thread-info
17824 @end smallexample
17825
17826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17827
17828 No equivalent.
17829
17830 @subsubheading Example
17831 N.A.
17832
17833
17834 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
17835 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
17836
17837 @subsubheading Synopsis
17838
17839 @smallexample
17840 -thread-list-all-threads
17841 @end smallexample
17842
17843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17844
17845 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
17846
17847 @subsubheading Example
17848 N.A.
17849
17850
17851 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
17852 @findex -thread-list-ids
17853
17854 @subsubheading Synopsis
17855
17856 @smallexample
17857 -thread-list-ids
17858 @end smallexample
17859
17860 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
17861 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
17862
17863 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17864
17865 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
17866
17867 @subsubheading Example
17868
17869 No threads present, besides the main process:
17870
17871 @smallexample
17872 (@value{GDBP})
17873 -thread-list-ids
17874 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
17875 (@value{GDBP})
17876 @end smallexample
17877
17878
17879 Several threads:
17880
17881 @smallexample
17882 (@value{GDBP})
17883 -thread-list-ids
17884 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17885 number-of-threads="3"
17886 (@value{GDBP})
17887 @end smallexample
17888
17889
17890 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
17891 @findex -thread-select
17892
17893 @subsubheading Synopsis
17894
17895 @smallexample
17896 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
17897 @end smallexample
17898
17899 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
17900 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
17901
17902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17903
17904 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
17905
17906 @subsubheading Example
17907
17908 @smallexample
17909 (@value{GDBP})
17910 -exec-next
17911 ^running
17912 (@value{GDBP})
17913 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
17914 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
17915 (@value{GDBP})
17916 -thread-list-ids
17917 ^done,
17918 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17919 number-of-threads="3"
17920 (@value{GDBP})
17921 -thread-select 3
17922 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
17923 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
17924 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
17925 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
17926 (@value{GDBP})
17927 @end smallexample
17928
17929 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17930 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
17931 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
17932
17933 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
17934
17935 @c @subheading -trace-actions
17936
17937 @c @subheading -trace-delete
17938
17939 @c @subheading -trace-disable
17940
17941 @c @subheading -trace-dump
17942
17943 @c @subheading -trace-enable
17944
17945 @c @subheading -trace-exists
17946
17947 @c @subheading -trace-find
17948
17949 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
17950
17951 @c @subheading -trace-info
17952
17953 @c @subheading -trace-insert
17954
17955 @c @subheading -trace-list
17956
17957 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
17958
17959 @c @subheading -trace-save
17960
17961 @c @subheading -trace-start
17962
17963 @c @subheading -trace-stop
17964
17965
17966 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17967 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
17968 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
17969
17970
17971 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17972
17973 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
17974 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
17975 used by @code{Insight}.
17976
17977 The two main reasons for that are:
17978
17979 @enumerate 1
17980 @item
17981 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
17982
17983 @item
17984 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
17985 now).
17986 @end enumerate
17987
17988 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
17989 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
17990 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
17991 hints about their use.
17992
17993 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
17994 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
17995 least, the following operations:
17996
17997 @itemize @bullet
17998 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
17999 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
18000 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
18001 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
18002 @end itemize
18003
18004 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
18005
18006 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
18007 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
18008 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
18009 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
18010 examining or changing its properties.
18011
18012 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
18013 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
18014 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
18015 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
18016 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
18017
18018 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
18019 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
18020 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
18021 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
18022 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
18023 for pointers, etc.).
18024
18025 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
18026 access this functionality:
18027
18028 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
18029 @item @strong{Operation}
18030 @tab @strong{Description}
18031
18032 @item @code{-var-create}
18033 @tab create a variable object
18034 @item @code{-var-delete}
18035 @tab delete the variable object and its children
18036 @item @code{-var-set-format}
18037 @tab set the display format of this variable
18038 @item @code{-var-show-format}
18039 @tab show the display format of this variable
18040 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
18041 @tab tells how many children this object has
18042 @item @code{-var-list-children}
18043 @tab return a list of the object's children
18044 @item @code{-var-info-type}
18045 @tab show the type of this variable object
18046 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
18047 @tab print what this variable object represents
18048 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
18049 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
18050 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
18051 @tab get the value of this variable
18052 @item @code{-var-assign}
18053 @tab set the value of this variable
18054 @item @code{-var-update}
18055 @tab update the variable and its children
18056 @end multitable
18057
18058 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
18059 how it can be used.
18060
18061 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
18062
18063 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
18064 @findex -var-create
18065
18066 @subsubheading Synopsis
18067
18068 @smallexample
18069 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
18070 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
18071 @end smallexample
18072
18073 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
18074 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
18075 register.
18076
18077 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
18078 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
18079 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
18080 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
18081 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
18082
18083 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
18084 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
18085 frame should be used.
18086
18087 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
18088 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
18089
18090 @itemize @bullet
18091 @item
18092 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
18093
18094 @item
18095 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
18096
18097 @item
18098 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
18099 @end itemize
18100
18101 @subsubheading Result
18102
18103 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
18104 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
18105 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
18106
18107 @smallexample
18108 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
18109 @end smallexample
18110
18111
18112 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
18113 @findex -var-delete
18114
18115 @subsubheading Synopsis
18116
18117 @smallexample
18118 -var-delete @var{name}
18119 @end smallexample
18120
18121 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
18122
18123 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
18124
18125
18126 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
18127 @findex -var-set-format
18128
18129 @subsubheading Synopsis
18130
18131 @smallexample
18132 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
18133 @end smallexample
18134
18135 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
18136 @var{format-spec}.
18137
18138 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
18139
18140 @smallexample
18141 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
18142 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
18143 @end smallexample
18144
18145
18146 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
18147 @findex -var-show-format
18148
18149 @subsubheading Synopsis
18150
18151 @smallexample
18152 -var-show-format @var{name}
18153 @end smallexample
18154
18155 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
18156
18157 @smallexample
18158 @var{format} @expansion{}
18159 @var{format-spec}
18160 @end smallexample
18161
18162
18163 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
18164 @findex -var-info-num-children
18165
18166 @subsubheading Synopsis
18167
18168 @smallexample
18169 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
18170 @end smallexample
18171
18172 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
18173
18174 @smallexample
18175 numchild=@var{n}
18176 @end smallexample
18177
18178
18179 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
18180 @findex -var-list-children
18181
18182 @subsubheading Synopsis
18183
18184 @smallexample
18185 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
18186 @end smallexample
18187
18188 Returns a list of the children of the specified variable object. With
18189 just the variable object name as an argument or with an optional
18190 preceding argument of 0 or @code{--no-values}, prints only the names of the
18191 variables. With an optional preceding argument of 1 or @code{--all-values},
18192 also prints their values.
18193
18194 @subsubheading Example
18195
18196 @smallexample
18197 (@value{GDBP})
18198 -var-list-children n
18199 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
18200 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
18201 (@value{GDBP})
18202 -var-list-children --all-values n
18203 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
18204 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
18205 @end smallexample
18206
18207
18208 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
18209 @findex -var-info-type
18210
18211 @subsubheading Synopsis
18212
18213 @smallexample
18214 -var-info-type @var{name}
18215 @end smallexample
18216
18217 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
18218 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
18219 @value{GDBN} CLI:
18220
18221 @smallexample
18222 type=@var{typename}
18223 @end smallexample
18224
18225
18226 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
18227 @findex -var-info-expression
18228
18229 @subsubheading Synopsis
18230
18231 @smallexample
18232 -var-info-expression @var{name}
18233 @end smallexample
18234
18235 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
18236
18237 @smallexample
18238 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
18239 @end smallexample
18240
18241 @noindent
18242 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
18243
18244 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
18245 @findex -var-show-attributes
18246
18247 @subsubheading Synopsis
18248
18249 @smallexample
18250 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
18251 @end smallexample
18252
18253 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
18254
18255 @smallexample
18256 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
18257 @end smallexample
18258
18259 @noindent
18260 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
18261
18262 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
18263 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
18264
18265 @subsubheading Synopsis
18266
18267 @smallexample
18268 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
18269 @end smallexample
18270
18271 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
18272 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
18273 for the object:
18274
18275 @smallexample
18276 value=@var{value}
18277 @end smallexample
18278
18279 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
18280 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
18281
18282 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
18283 @findex -var-assign
18284
18285 @subsubheading Synopsis
18286
18287 @smallexample
18288 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
18289 @end smallexample
18290
18291 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
18292 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
18293 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
18294 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
18295
18296 @subsubheading Example
18297
18298 @smallexample
18299 (@value{GDBP})
18300 -var-assign var1 3
18301 ^done,value="3"
18302 (@value{GDBP})
18303 -var-update *
18304 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
18305 (@value{GDBP})
18306 @end smallexample
18307
18308 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
18309 @findex -var-update
18310
18311 @subsubheading Synopsis
18312
18313 @smallexample
18314 -var-update @{@var{name} | "*"@}
18315 @end smallexample
18316
18317 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
18318 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
18319 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated.
18320
18321
18322 @node Annotations
18323 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
18324
18325 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
18326 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
18327 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
18328 relatively high level.
18329
18330 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
18331 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
18332
18333 @ignore
18334 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
18335 @end ignore
18336
18337 @menu
18338 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
18339 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
18340 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
18341 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
18342 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
18343 * Annotations for Running::
18344 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
18345 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
18346 @end menu
18347
18348 @node Annotations Overview
18349 @section What is an Annotation?
18350 @cindex annotations
18351
18352 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
18353 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
18354 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
18355 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
18356 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
18357 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
18358 cannot contain newline characters.
18359
18360 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
18361 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
18362 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
18363 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
18364 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
18365 means those three characters as output.
18366
18367 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
18368 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
18369 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
18370 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
18371 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
18372 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
18373 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
18374 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
18375 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}). This chapter
18376 describes level 3 annotations.
18377
18378 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
18379
18380 @smallexample
18381 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
18382 GNU gdb 6.0
18383 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
18384 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
18385 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
18386 under certain conditions.
18387 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
18388 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
18389 for details.
18390 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
18391
18392 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
18393 (gdb)
18394 ^Z^Zprompt
18395 @kbd{quit}
18396
18397 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
18398 $
18399 @end smallexample
18400
18401 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
18402 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
18403 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
18404 output from @value{GDBN}.
18405
18406 @node Server Prefix
18407 @section The Server Prefix
18408 @cindex server prefix for annotations
18409
18410 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18411 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
18412 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18413 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18414 pressed on a line by itself.
18415
18416 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18417 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18418 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18419
18420 @node Prompting
18421 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
18422
18423 @cindex annotations for prompts
18424 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
18425 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
18426 over, etc.
18427
18428 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
18429 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
18430 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
18431 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
18432 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
18433 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
18434 features the following annotations:
18435
18436 @smallexample
18437 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
18438 ^Z^Zprompt
18439 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
18440 @end smallexample
18441
18442 The input types are
18443
18444 @table @code
18445 @findex pre-prompt
18446 @findex prompt
18447 @findex post-prompt
18448 @item prompt
18449 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
18450
18451 @findex pre-commands
18452 @findex commands
18453 @findex post-commands
18454 @item commands
18455 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
18456 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
18457
18458 @findex pre-overload-choice
18459 @findex overload-choice
18460 @findex post-overload-choice
18461 @item overload-choice
18462 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
18463
18464 @findex pre-query
18465 @findex query
18466 @findex post-query
18467 @item query
18468 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
18469
18470 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
18471 @findex prompt-for-continue
18472 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
18473 @item prompt-for-continue
18474 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
18475 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
18476 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
18477 presence of annotations.
18478 @end table
18479
18480 @node Errors
18481 @section Errors
18482 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
18483
18484 @findex quit
18485 @smallexample
18486 ^Z^Zquit
18487 @end smallexample
18488
18489 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
18490
18491 @findex error
18492 @smallexample
18493 ^Z^Zerror
18494 @end smallexample
18495
18496 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
18497
18498 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
18499 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
18500 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
18501 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
18502 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
18503 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
18504 to the top level.
18505
18506 @findex error-begin
18507 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
18508
18509 @smallexample
18510 ^Z^Zerror-begin
18511 @end smallexample
18512
18513 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
18514 message.
18515
18516 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
18517 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
18518 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
18519
18520 @node Invalidation
18521 @section Invalidation Notices
18522
18523 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
18524 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
18525 changed.
18526
18527 @table @code
18528 @findex frames-invalid
18529 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
18530
18531 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
18532 have changed.
18533
18534 @findex breakpoints-invalid
18535 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
18536
18537 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
18538 deleted a breakpoint.
18539 @end table
18540
18541 @node Annotations for Running
18542 @section Running the Program
18543 @cindex annotations for running programs
18544
18545 @findex starting
18546 @findex stopping
18547 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
18548 @code{step} or @code{continue},
18549
18550 @smallexample
18551 ^Z^Zstarting
18552 @end smallexample
18553
18554 is output. When the program stops,
18555
18556 @smallexample
18557 ^Z^Zstopped
18558 @end smallexample
18559
18560 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
18561 annotations describe how the program stopped.
18562
18563 @table @code
18564 @findex exited
18565 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
18566 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
18567 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
18568
18569 @findex signalled
18570 @findex signal-name
18571 @findex signal-name-end
18572 @findex signal-string
18573 @findex signal-string-end
18574 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
18575 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
18576 annotation continues:
18577
18578 @smallexample
18579 @var{intro-text}
18580 ^Z^Zsignal-name
18581 @var{name}
18582 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
18583 @var{middle-text}
18584 ^Z^Zsignal-string
18585 @var{string}
18586 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
18587 @var{end-text}
18588 @end smallexample
18589
18590 @noindent
18591 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
18592 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
18593 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
18594 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
18595 user's benefit and have no particular format.
18596
18597 @findex signal
18598 @item ^Z^Zsignal
18599 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
18600 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
18601 terminated with it.
18602
18603 @findex breakpoint
18604 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
18605 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
18606
18607 @findex watchpoint
18608 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
18609 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
18610 @end table
18611
18612 @node Source Annotations
18613 @section Displaying Source
18614 @cindex annotations for source display
18615
18616 @findex source
18617 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
18618
18619 @smallexample
18620 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
18621 @end smallexample
18622
18623 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
18624 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
18625 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
18626 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
18627 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
18628 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
18629 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
18630 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
18631 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
18632 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
18633 depend on the language).
18634
18635 @node GDB Bugs
18636 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
18637 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
18638 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
18639
18640 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
18641
18642 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
18643 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
18644 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
18645 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
18646
18647 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
18648 information that enables us to fix the bug.
18649
18650 @menu
18651 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
18652 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
18653 @end menu
18654
18655 @node Bug Criteria
18656 @section Have you found a bug?
18657 @cindex bug criteria
18658
18659 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
18660
18661 @itemize @bullet
18662 @cindex fatal signal
18663 @cindex debugger crash
18664 @cindex crash of debugger
18665 @item
18666 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
18667 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
18668
18669 @cindex error on valid input
18670 @item
18671 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
18672 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
18673 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
18674
18675 @cindex invalid input
18676 @item
18677 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
18678 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
18679 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
18680 for traditional practice''.
18681
18682 @item
18683 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
18684 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
18685 @end itemize
18686
18687 @node Bug Reporting
18688 @section How to report bugs
18689 @cindex bug reports
18690 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
18691
18692 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
18693 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
18694 contact that organization first.
18695
18696 You can find contact information for many support companies and
18697 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
18698 distribution.
18699 @c should add a web page ref...
18700
18701 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
18702 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
18703 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
18704 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
18705 be used.
18706
18707 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
18708 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
18709 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
18710 @samp{bug-gdb}.
18711
18712 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
18713 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
18714 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
18715 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
18716 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
18717 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
18718 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
18719 bug reports to the mailing list.
18720
18721 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
18722 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
18723 fact or leave it out, state it!
18724
18725 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
18726 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
18727 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
18728 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
18729 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
18730 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
18731 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
18732 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
18733 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
18734
18735 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
18736 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
18737 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
18738 self-contained.
18739
18740 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
18741 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
18742 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
18743 bugs properly.
18744
18745 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
18746
18747 @itemize @bullet
18748 @item
18749 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
18750 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
18751 version}.
18752
18753 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
18754 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
18755
18756 @item
18757 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
18758 version number.
18759
18760 @item
18761 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
18762 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
18763
18764 @item
18765 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
18766 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
18767 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
18768 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
18769 compilers.
18770
18771 @item
18772 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
18773 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
18774 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
18775 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
18776
18777 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
18778 and then we might not encounter the bug.
18779
18780 @item
18781 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
18782 reproduce the bug.
18783
18784 @item
18785 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
18786 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
18787
18788 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
18789 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
18790 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
18791 a chance to make a mistake.
18792
18793 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
18794 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
18795 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
18796 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
18797 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
18798 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
18799 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
18800 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
18801
18802 @item
18803 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
18804 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
18805 it by context, not by line number.
18806
18807 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
18808 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
18809
18810 @end itemize
18811
18812 Here are some things that are not necessary:
18813
18814 @itemize @bullet
18815 @item
18816 A description of the envelope of the bug.
18817
18818 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
18819 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
18820 changes will not affect it.
18821
18822 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
18823 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
18824 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
18825 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
18826
18827 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
18828 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
18829 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
18830 less time, and so on.
18831
18832 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
18833 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
18834
18835 @item
18836 A patch for the bug.
18837
18838 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
18839 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
18840 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
18841 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
18842
18843 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
18844 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
18845 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
18846 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
18847
18848 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
18849 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
18850 help us to understand.
18851
18852 @item
18853 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
18854
18855 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
18856 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
18857 @end itemize
18858
18859 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
18860 @c and consists of the two following files:
18861 @c rluser.texinfo
18862 @c inc-hist.texinfo
18863 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
18864 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
18865 @include rluser.texinfo
18866 @include inc-hist.texinfo
18867
18868
18869 @node Formatting Documentation
18870 @appendix Formatting Documentation
18871
18872 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
18873 @cindex reference card
18874 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
18875 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
18876 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
18877 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
18878 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
18879 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
18880
18881 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
18882 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
18883
18884 @smallexample
18885 make refcard.dvi
18886 @end smallexample
18887
18888 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
18889 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
18890 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
18891 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
18892 your @sc{dvi} output program.
18893
18894 @cindex documentation
18895
18896 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
18897 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
18898 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
18899 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
18900 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
18901 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
18902
18903 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
18904 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
18905 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
18906 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
18907 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
18908 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
18909 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
18910 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
18911
18912 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
18913 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
18914 @code{makeinfo}.
18915
18916 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
18917 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
18918 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
18919
18920 @smallexample
18921 cd gdb
18922 make gdb.info
18923 @end smallexample
18924
18925 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
18926 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
18927 Texinfo definitions file.
18928
18929 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
18930 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
18931 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
18932 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
18933 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
18934 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
18935 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
18936
18937 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
18938 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
18939 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
18940 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
18941 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
18942 directory.
18943
18944 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
18945 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
18946 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
18947 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
18948
18949 @smallexample
18950 make gdb.dvi
18951 @end smallexample
18952
18953 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
18954
18955 @node Installing GDB
18956 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
18957 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
18958 @cindex installation
18959 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
18960
18961 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
18962 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
18963 build the @code{gdb} program.
18964 @iftex
18965 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
18966 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
18967 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
18968 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
18969 @end iftex
18970
18971 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
18972 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
18973 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
18974
18975 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
18976 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
18977
18978 @table @code
18979 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
18980 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
18981
18982 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
18983 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
18984
18985 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
18986 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
18987
18988 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
18989 @sc{gnu} include files
18990
18991 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
18992 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
18993
18994 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
18995 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
18996
18997 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
18998 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
18999
19000 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
19001 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
19002
19003 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
19004 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
19005 @end table
19006
19007 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
19008 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
19009 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
19010
19011 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
19012 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
19013 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
19014 argument.
19015
19016 For example:
19017
19018 @smallexample
19019 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19020 ./configure @var{host}
19021 make
19022 @end smallexample
19023
19024 @noindent
19025 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
19026 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
19027 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
19028 correct value by examining your system.)
19029
19030 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
19031 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
19032 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
19033 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
19034
19035 @need 750
19036 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
19037 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
19038 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
19039
19040 @smallexample
19041 sh configure @var{host}
19042 @end smallexample
19043
19044 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
19045 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
19046 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
19047 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
19048 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
19049
19050 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
19051 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
19052 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
19053 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
19054 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
19055 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
19056 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
19057 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
19058 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
19059
19060 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
19061 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
19062 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
19063 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
19064 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
19065
19066 @menu
19067 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
19068 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
19069 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
19070 @end menu
19071
19072 @node Separate Objdir
19073 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
19074
19075 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
19076 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
19077 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
19078 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
19079 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
19080 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
19081 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
19082 program specified there.
19083
19084 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
19085 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
19086 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
19087 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
19088 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
19089 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
19090
19091 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
19092 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
19093
19094 @smallexample
19095 @group
19096 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19097 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
19098 cd ../gdb-sun4
19099 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
19100 make
19101 @end group
19102 @end smallexample
19103
19104 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
19105 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
19106 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
19107 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
19108 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
19109 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
19110
19111 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
19112 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
19113 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
19114 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
19115 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
19116
19117 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
19118 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
19119 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
19120 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
19121 You specify a cross-debugging target by
19122 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
19123
19124 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
19125 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
19126 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
19127
19128 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
19129 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
19130 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
19131 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
19132 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
19133
19134 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
19135 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
19136 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
19137 with each other.
19138
19139 @node Config Names
19140 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
19141
19142 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
19143 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
19144 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
19145 of information in the following pattern:
19146
19147 @smallexample
19148 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
19149 @end smallexample
19150
19151 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
19152 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
19153 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
19154
19155 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
19156 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
19157 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
19158 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
19159 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
19160 abbreviations---for example:
19161
19162 @smallexample
19163 % sh config.sub i386-linux
19164 i386-pc-linux-gnu
19165 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
19166 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
19167 % sh config.sub hp9k700
19168 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
19169 % sh config.sub sun4
19170 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
19171 % sh config.sub sun3
19172 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
19173 % sh config.sub i986v
19174 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
19175 @end smallexample
19176
19177 @noindent
19178 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
19179 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
19180
19181 @node Configure Options
19182 @section @code{configure} options
19183
19184 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
19185 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
19186 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
19187 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
19188
19189 @smallexample
19190 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
19191 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19192 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19193 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
19194 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
19195 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
19196 @var{host}
19197 @end smallexample
19198
19199 @noindent
19200 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
19201 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
19202 @samp{--}.
19203
19204 @table @code
19205 @item --help
19206 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
19207
19208 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
19209 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
19210 @file{@var{dir}}.
19211
19212 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
19213 Configure the source to install programs under directory
19214 @file{@var{dir}}.
19215
19216 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
19217 @need 2000
19218 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
19219 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
19220 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
19221 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
19222 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
19223 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
19224 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
19225 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
19226 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
19227 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
19228 @var{dirname}.
19229
19230 @item --norecursion
19231 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
19232 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
19233
19234 @item --target=@var{target}
19235 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
19236 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
19237 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
19238
19239 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
19240
19241 @item @var{host} @dots{}
19242 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
19243
19244 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
19245 @end table
19246
19247 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
19248 needed for special purposes only.
19249
19250 @node Maintenance Commands
19251 @appendix Maintenance Commands
19252 @cindex maintenance commands
19253 @cindex internal commands
19254
19255 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
19256 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
19257 These commands are provided here for reference.
19258
19259 @table @code
19260 @kindex maint info breakpoints
19261 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
19262 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
19263 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
19264 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
19265 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
19266 is shown:
19267
19268 @table @code
19269 @item breakpoint
19270 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
19271
19272 @item watchpoint
19273 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
19274
19275 @item longjmp
19276 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
19277 @code{longjmp} calls.
19278
19279 @item longjmp resume
19280 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
19281
19282 @item until
19283 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
19284
19285 @item finish
19286 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
19287
19288 @item shlib events
19289 Shared library events.
19290
19291 @end table
19292
19293 @kindex maint internal-error
19294 @kindex maint internal-warning
19295 @item maint internal-error
19296 @itemx maint internal-warning
19297 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
19298 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
19299 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
19300 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
19301 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
19302 @value{GDBN} session.
19303
19304 @smallexample
19305 (gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
19306 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
19307 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
19308 debugging may prove unreliable.
19309 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19310 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19311 (gdb)
19312 @end smallexample
19313
19314 Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
19315 warning message.
19316
19317 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
19318 @item maint print dummy-frames
19319
19320 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
19321
19322 @smallexample
19323 (gdb) @kbd{b add}
19324 @dots{}
19325 (gdb) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
19326 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
19327 58 return (a + b);
19328 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
19329 @dots{}
19330 (gdb) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
19331 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
19332 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
19333 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
19334 (gdb)
19335 @end smallexample
19336
19337 Takes an optional file parameter.
19338
19339 @kindex maint print registers
19340 @kindex maint print raw-registers
19341 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
19342 @kindex maint print register-groups
19343 @item maint print registers
19344 @itemx maint print raw-registers
19345 @itemx maint print cooked-registers
19346 @itemx maint print register-groups
19347 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
19348
19349 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
19350 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
19351 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
19352 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
19353 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
19354 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
19355
19356 Takes an optional file parameter.
19357
19358 @kindex maint print reggroups
19359 @item maint print reggroups
19360 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
19361
19362 Takes an optional file parameter.
19363
19364 @smallexample
19365 (gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
19366 Group Type
19367 general user
19368 float user
19369 all user
19370 vector user
19371 system user
19372 save internal
19373 restore internal
19374 @end smallexample
19375
19376 @kindex maint set profile
19377 @kindex maint show profile
19378 @cindex profiling GDB
19379 @item maint set profile
19380 @itemx maint show profile
19381 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
19382
19383 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
19384 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
19385 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
19386 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
19387 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
19388 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
19389 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
19390
19391 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
19392 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
19393
19394 @end table
19395
19396
19397 @node Remote Protocol
19398 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
19399
19400 @menu
19401 * Overview::
19402 * Packets::
19403 * Stop Reply Packets::
19404 * General Query Packets::
19405 * Register Packet Format::
19406 * Examples::
19407 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
19408 @end menu
19409
19410 @node Overview
19411 @section Overview
19412
19413 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
19414 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
19415 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
19416 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
19417
19418 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
19419 transmitted and received data respectfully.
19420
19421 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
19422 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
19423 @cindex remote serial protocol
19424 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
19425 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
19426 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
19427 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
19428
19429 @smallexample
19430 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19431 @end smallexample
19432 @noindent
19433
19434 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
19435 @noindent
19436 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
19437 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
19438 eight bit unsigned checksum).
19439
19440 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
19441 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
19442
19443 @smallexample
19444 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19445 @end smallexample
19446
19447 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
19448 @noindent
19449 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
19450 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
19451 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
19452
19453 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
19454 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
19455 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
19456 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
19457 retransmission):
19458
19459 @smallexample
19460 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19461 <- @code{+}
19462 @end smallexample
19463 @noindent
19464
19465 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
19466 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
19467 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
19468 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
19469
19470 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
19471 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
19472 exceptions).
19473
19474 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
19475 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
19476 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
19477 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
19478
19479 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
19480 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
19481 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
19482
19483 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
19484 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
19485 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
19486 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
19487 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
19488 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
19489 value greater than 126 should not be used.
19490
19491 So:
19492 @smallexample
19493 "@code{0* }"
19494 @end smallexample
19495 @noindent
19496 means the same as "0000".
19497
19498 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
19499 error number. That number is not well defined.
19500
19501 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
19502 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
19503 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
19504 on that response.
19505
19506 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
19507 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
19508 optional.
19509
19510 @node Packets
19511 @section Packets
19512
19513 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
19514 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
19515
19516 @table @r
19517
19518 @item @code{!} --- extended mode
19519 @cindex @code{!} packet
19520
19521 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
19522 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
19523 debugged.
19524
19525 Reply:
19526 @table @samp
19527 @item OK
19528 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
19529 @end table
19530
19531 @item @code{?} --- last signal
19532 @cindex @code{?} packet
19533
19534 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
19535 step and continue.
19536
19537 Reply:
19538 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19539
19540 @item @code{a} --- reserved
19541
19542 Reserved for future use.
19543
19544 @item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
19545 @cindex @code{A} packet
19546
19547 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
19548 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
19549 See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
19550
19551 Reply:
19552 @table @samp
19553 @item OK
19554 @item E@var{NN}
19555 @end table
19556
19557 @item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
19558 @cindex @code{b} packet
19559
19560 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
19561
19562 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
19563 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
19564 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
19565
19566 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
19567 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
19568 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
19569 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
19570 of view, nothing actually happened.}
19571
19572 @item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
19573 @cindex @code{B} packet
19574
19575 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
19576 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
19577
19578 This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
19579 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
19580
19581 @item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
19582 @cindex @code{c} packet
19583
19584 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19585 current address.
19586
19587 Reply:
19588 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19589
19590 @item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
19591 @cindex @code{C} packet
19592
19593 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
19594 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
19595
19596 Reply:
19597 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19598
19599 @item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
19600 @cindex @code{d} packet
19601
19602 Toggle debug flag.
19603
19604 @item @code{D} --- detach
19605 @cindex @code{D} packet
19606
19607 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
19608 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
19609
19610 Reply:
19611 @table @samp
19612 @item @emph{no response}
19613 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
19614 @end table
19615
19616 @item @code{e} --- reserved
19617
19618 Reserved for future use.
19619
19620 @item @code{E} --- reserved
19621
19622 Reserved for future use.
19623
19624 @item @code{f} --- reserved
19625
19626 Reserved for future use.
19627
19628 @item @code{F}@var{RC}@code{,}@var{EE}@code{,}@var{CF}@code{;}@var{XX} --- Reply to target's F packet.
19629 @cindex @code{F} packet
19630
19631 This packet is send by @value{GDBN} as reply to a @code{F} request packet
19632 sent by the target. This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.
19633 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
19634
19635 @item @code{g} --- read registers
19636 @anchor{read registers packet}
19637 @cindex @code{g} packet
19638
19639 Read general registers.
19640
19641 Reply:
19642 @table @samp
19643 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19644 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
19645 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
19646 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
19647 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
19648 @var{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
19649 specification of several standard @code{g} packets is specified below.
19650 @item E@var{NN}
19651 for an error.
19652 @end table
19653
19654 @item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
19655 @cindex @code{G} packet
19656
19657 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
19658 data.
19659
19660 Reply:
19661 @table @samp
19662 @item OK
19663 for success
19664 @item E@var{NN}
19665 for an error
19666 @end table
19667
19668 @item @code{h} --- reserved
19669
19670 Reserved for future use.
19671
19672 @item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
19673 @cindex @code{H} packet
19674
19675 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
19676 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
19677 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
19678 operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
19679 the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
19680
19681 Reply:
19682 @table @samp
19683 @item OK
19684 for success
19685 @item E@var{NN}
19686 for an error
19687 @end table
19688
19689 @c FIXME: JTC:
19690 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
19691 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
19692 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
19693 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
19694 @c described. For example:
19695 @c
19696 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19697 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
19698 @c otherwise returns current registers.
19699 @c
19700 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19701 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
19702 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
19703
19704 @item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
19705 @anchor{cycle step packet}
19706 @cindex @code{i} packet
19707
19708 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
19709 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
19710 step starting at that address.
19711
19712 @item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
19713 @cindex @code{I} packet
19714
19715 @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
19716
19717 @item @code{j} --- reserved
19718
19719 Reserved for future use.
19720
19721 @item @code{J} --- reserved
19722
19723 Reserved for future use.
19724
19725 @item @code{k} --- kill request
19726 @cindex @code{k} packet
19727
19728 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
19729 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
19730 thread?)}.
19731
19732 @item @code{K} --- reserved
19733
19734 Reserved for future use.
19735
19736 @item @code{l} --- reserved
19737
19738 Reserved for future use.
19739
19740 @item @code{L} --- reserved
19741
19742 Reserved for future use.
19743
19744 @item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
19745 @cindex @code{m} packet
19746
19747 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
19748 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
19749 assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
19750 transfer mechanism is needed.}
19751
19752 Reply:
19753 @table @samp
19754 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19755 @var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
19756 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
19757 that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
19758 accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
19759 needed.}
19760 @item E@var{NN}
19761 @var{NN} is errno
19762 @end table
19763
19764 @item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
19765 @cindex @code{M} packet
19766
19767 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
19768 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
19769
19770 Reply:
19771 @table @samp
19772 @item OK
19773 for success
19774 @item E@var{NN}
19775 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
19776 written).
19777 @end table
19778
19779 @item @code{n} --- reserved
19780
19781 Reserved for future use.
19782
19783 @item @code{N} --- reserved
19784
19785 Reserved for future use.
19786
19787 @item @code{o} --- reserved
19788
19789 Reserved for future use.
19790
19791 @item @code{O} --- reserved
19792
19793 Reserved for future use.
19794
19795 @item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
19796 @cindex @code{p} packet
19797
19798 @xref{write register packet}.
19799
19800 Reply:
19801 @table @samp
19802 @item @var{r@dots{}.}
19803 The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
19804 @end table
19805
19806 @item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
19807 @anchor{write register packet}
19808 @cindex @code{P} packet
19809
19810 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
19811 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
19812
19813 Reply:
19814 @table @samp
19815 @item OK
19816 for success
19817 @item E@var{NN}
19818 for an error
19819 @end table
19820
19821 @item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
19822 @anchor{general query packet}
19823 @cindex @code{q} packet
19824
19825 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
19826 leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
19827 prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
19828 be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
19829 that they match the full @var{query} name.
19830
19831 Reply:
19832 @table @samp
19833 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19834 Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
19835 @item E@var{NN}
19836 error reply
19837 @item
19838 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
19839 @end table
19840
19841 @item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
19842 @cindex @code{Q} packet
19843
19844 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
19845
19846 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
19847
19848 @item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
19849 @cindex @code{r} packet
19850
19851 Reset the entire system.
19852
19853 @item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
19854 @cindex @code{R} packet
19855
19856 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
19857 This packet is only available in extended mode.
19858
19859 Reply:
19860 @table @samp
19861 @item @emph{no reply}
19862 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
19863 @end table
19864
19865 @item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
19866 @cindex @code{s} packet
19867
19868 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19869 same address.
19870
19871 Reply:
19872 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19873
19874 @item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
19875 @anchor{step with signal packet}
19876 @cindex @code{S} packet
19877
19878 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
19879
19880 Reply:
19881 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19882
19883 @item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
19884 @cindex @code{t} packet
19885
19886 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
19887 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
19888 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
19889
19890 @item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
19891 @cindex @code{T} packet
19892
19893 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
19894
19895 Reply:
19896 @table @samp
19897 @item OK
19898 thread is still alive
19899 @item E@var{NN}
19900 thread is dead
19901 @end table
19902
19903 @item @code{u} --- reserved
19904
19905 Reserved for future use.
19906
19907 @item @code{U} --- reserved
19908
19909 Reserved for future use.
19910
19911 @item @code{v} --- verbose packet prefix
19912
19913 Packets starting with @code{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
19914 up to the first @code{;} or @code{?} (or the end of the packet).
19915
19916 @item @code{vCont}[;@var{action}[@code{:}@var{tid}]]... --- extended resume
19917 @cindex @code{vCont} packet
19918
19919 Resume the inferior. Different actions may be specified for each thread.
19920 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
19921 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
19922 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
19923 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
19924 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
19925
19926 @table @code
19927 @item c
19928 Continue.
19929 @item C@var{sig}
19930 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
19931 @item s
19932 Step.
19933 @item S@var{sig}
19934 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
19935 @end table
19936
19937 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
19938 not supported in @code{vCont}.
19939
19940 Reply:
19941 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19942
19943 @item @code{vCont?} --- extended resume query
19944 @cindex @code{vCont?} packet
19945
19946 Query support for the @code{vCont} packet.
19947
19948 Reply:
19949 @table @samp
19950 @item @code{vCont}[;@var{action}]...
19951 The @code{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
19952 command in the @code{vCont} packet.
19953 @item
19954 The @code{vCont} packet is not supported.
19955 @end table
19956
19957 @item @code{V} --- reserved
19958
19959 Reserved for future use.
19960
19961 @item @code{w} --- reserved
19962
19963 Reserved for future use.
19964
19965 @item @code{W} --- reserved
19966
19967 Reserved for future use.
19968
19969 @item @code{x} --- reserved
19970
19971 Reserved for future use.
19972
19973 @item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
19974 @cindex @code{X} packet
19975
19976 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
19977 is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
19978 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
19979
19980 Reply:
19981 @table @samp
19982 @item OK
19983 for success
19984 @item E@var{NN}
19985 for an error
19986 @end table
19987
19988 @item @code{y} --- reserved
19989
19990 Reserved for future use.
19991
19992 @item @code{Y} reserved
19993
19994 Reserved for future use.
19995
19996 @item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19997 @itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19998 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
19999 @cindex @code{z} packet
20000 @cindex @code{Z} packets
20001
20002 Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
20003 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
20004 @var{length} bytes.
20005
20006 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
20007 separately.
20008
20009 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
20010 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
20011 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
20012 @code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
20013 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
20014 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
20015
20016 @item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20017 @item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20018 @cindex @code{z0} packet
20019 @cindex @code{Z0} packet
20020
20021 Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
20022 @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
20023
20024 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
20025 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
20026 @code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
20027 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
20028 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
20029
20030 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
20031 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
20032 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
20033 target, is not defined.}
20034
20035 Reply:
20036 @table @samp
20037 @item OK
20038 success
20039 @item
20040 not supported
20041 @item E@var{NN}
20042 for an error
20043 @end table
20044
20045 @item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20046 @item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20047 @cindex @code{z1} packet
20048 @cindex @code{Z1} packet
20049
20050 Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
20051 address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
20052
20053 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
20054 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
20055
20056 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
20057 movement.}
20058
20059 Reply:
20060 @table @samp
20061 @item OK
20062 success
20063 @item
20064 not supported
20065 @item E@var{NN}
20066 for an error
20067 @end table
20068
20069 @item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20070 @item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20071 @cindex @code{z2} packet
20072 @cindex @code{Z2} packet
20073
20074 Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
20075
20076 Reply:
20077 @table @samp
20078 @item OK
20079 success
20080 @item
20081 not supported
20082 @item E@var{NN}
20083 for an error
20084 @end table
20085
20086 @item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20087 @item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20088 @cindex @code{z3} packet
20089 @cindex @code{Z3} packet
20090
20091 Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
20092
20093 Reply:
20094 @table @samp
20095 @item OK
20096 success
20097 @item
20098 not supported
20099 @item E@var{NN}
20100 for an error
20101 @end table
20102
20103 @item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20104 @item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20105 @cindex @code{z4} packet
20106 @cindex @code{Z4} packet
20107
20108 Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
20109
20110 Reply:
20111 @table @samp
20112 @item OK
20113 success
20114 @item
20115 not supported
20116 @item E@var{NN}
20117 for an error
20118 @end table
20119
20120 @end table
20121
20122 @node Stop Reply Packets
20123 @section Stop Reply Packets
20124 @cindex stop reply packets
20125
20126 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
20127 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
20128 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
20129 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
20130 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
20131 conventions is used.
20132
20133 @table @samp
20134
20135 @item S@var{AA}
20136 @var{AA} is the signal number
20137
20138 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
20139 @cindex @code{T} packet reply
20140
20141 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
20142 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
20143 by @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread},
20144 @var{r...} = thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} =
20145 (@samp{watch} | @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data
20146 address, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting
20147 with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...},
20148 @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can extend the
20149 protocol.
20150
20151 @item W@var{AA}
20152
20153 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
20154 applicable to certain targets.
20155
20156 @item X@var{AA}
20157
20158 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
20159
20160 @item O@var{XX@dots{}}
20161
20162 @var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
20163 any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
20164 to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
20165
20166 @item F@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20167
20168 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
20169 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
20170 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
20171 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
20172 system calls.
20173
20174 @var{parameter@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for this very
20175 system call.
20176
20177 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to call
20178 a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies with
20179 an appropriate @code{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next reply
20180 packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or
20181 @samp{s} action is expected to be continued.
20182 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for more details.
20183
20184 @end table
20185
20186 @node General Query Packets
20187 @section General Query Packets
20188
20189 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
20190
20191 @table @r
20192
20193 @item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
20194
20195 Return the current thread id.
20196
20197 Reply:
20198 @table @samp
20199 @item @code{QC}@var{pid}
20200 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
20201 @item *
20202 Any other reply implies the old pid.
20203 @end table
20204
20205 @item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
20206
20207 @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
20208
20209 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
20210 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
20211 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
20212 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
20213 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
20214 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
20215
20216 NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
20217
20218 Reply:
20219 @table @samp
20220 @item @code{m}@var{id}
20221 A single thread id
20222 @item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
20223 a comma-separated list of thread ids
20224 @item @code{l}
20225 (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
20226 @end table
20227
20228 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
20229 more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
20230 will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
20231 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
20232 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
20233
20234 @item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
20235
20236 Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
20237 string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
20238 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
20239 @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
20240 in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
20241 possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
20242 Mutex''.
20243
20244 Reply:
20245 @table @samp
20246 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
20247 Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
20248 the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
20249 attributes.
20250 @end table
20251
20252 @item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
20253
20254 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
20255 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
20256 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
20257 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
20258 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
20259 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
20260
20261 NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
20262 (see above).
20263
20264 Reply:
20265 @table @samp
20266 @item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
20267 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
20268 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
20269 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
20270 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
20271 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
20272 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
20273 @end table
20274
20275 @item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
20276
20277 Reply:
20278 @table @samp
20279 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
20280 An error (such as memory fault)
20281 @item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
20282 A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
20283 @end table
20284
20285 @item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
20286
20287 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
20288 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
20289 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
20290 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
20291
20292 Reply:
20293 @table @samp
20294 @item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
20295 @end table
20296
20297 @item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
20298
20299 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
20300 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
20301
20302 Reply:
20303 @table @samp
20304 @item *
20305 @end table
20306
20307 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
20308
20309 @item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
20310
20311 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
20312 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
20313 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
20314 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
20315 @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
20316 interpreter may have security implications}.
20317
20318 Reply:
20319 @table @samp
20320 @item OK
20321 A command response with no output.
20322 @item @var{OUTPUT}
20323 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
20324 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
20325 Indicate a badly formed request.
20326 @item @samp{}
20327 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
20328 @end table
20329
20330 @item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
20331
20332 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
20333 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
20334
20335 Reply:
20336 @table @samp
20337 @item @code{OK}
20338 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
20339 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20340 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
20341 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
20342 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
20343 @end table
20344
20345 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
20346
20347 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
20348
20349 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
20350 target has previously requested.
20351
20352 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
20353 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
20354 will be empty.
20355
20356 Reply:
20357 @table @samp
20358 @item @code{OK}
20359 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
20360 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20361 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
20362 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
20363 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
20364 @end table
20365
20366 @end table
20367
20368 @node Register Packet Format
20369 @section Register Packet Format
20370
20371 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
20372 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
20373 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
20374 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
20375 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
20376 most-significant - least-significant.
20377
20378 @table @r
20379
20380 @item MIPS32
20381
20382 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
20383 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
20384 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
20385
20386 @item MIPS64
20387
20388 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
20389 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
20390 as @code{MIPS32}.
20391
20392 @end table
20393
20394 @node Examples
20395 @section Examples
20396
20397 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
20398 does not get any direct output:
20399
20400 @smallexample
20401 -> @code{R00}
20402 <- @code{+}
20403 @emph{target restarts}
20404 -> @code{?}
20405 <- @code{+}
20406 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20407 -> @code{+}
20408 @end smallexample
20409
20410 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
20411
20412 @smallexample
20413 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
20414 <- @code{+}
20415 -> @code{s}
20416 <- @code{+}
20417 @emph{time passes}
20418 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20419 -> @code{+}
20420 -> @code{g}
20421 <- @code{+}
20422 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
20423 -> @code{+}
20424 @end smallexample
20425
20426 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
20427 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
20428 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
20429
20430 @menu
20431 * File-I/O Overview::
20432 * Protocol basics::
20433 * The F request packet::
20434 * The F reply packet::
20435 * Memory transfer::
20436 * The Ctrl-C message::
20437 * Console I/O::
20438 * The isatty call::
20439 * The system call::
20440 * List of supported calls::
20441 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
20442 * Constants::
20443 * File-I/O Examples::
20444 @end menu
20445
20446 @node File-I/O Overview
20447 @subsection File-I/O Overview
20448 @cindex file-i/o overview
20449
20450 The File I/O remote protocol extension (short: File-I/O) allows the
20451 target to use the hosts file system and console I/O when calling various
20452 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
20453 remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
20454 actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
20455 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
20456
20457 The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
20458 it's own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
20459 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
20460 translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
20461 when data is transmitted.
20462
20463 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
20464 when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
20465 packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
20466 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
20467 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
20468 is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
20469
20470 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
20471 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
20472 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
20473 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
20474 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
20475
20476 @smallexample
20477 (gdb) continue
20478 <- target requests 'system call X'
20479 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
20480 -> GDB returns result
20481 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
20482 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
20483 @end smallexample
20484
20485 The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
20486 for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
20487 named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
20488 system are not supported by this protocol.
20489
20490 @node Protocol basics
20491 @subsection Protocol basics
20492 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
20493
20494 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
20495 as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
20496 @value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
20497 File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
20498 of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
20499 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
20500 to call the appropriate host system call:
20501
20502 @itemize @bullet
20503 @item
20504 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
20505
20506 @item
20507 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
20508 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
20509 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
20510 Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
20511
20512 @end itemize
20513
20514 At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
20515
20516 @itemize @bullet
20517 @item
20518 If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
20519 to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
20520 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
20521 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
20522 packet.
20523
20524 @item
20525 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
20526 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
20527
20528 @item
20529 @value{GDBN} calls the system call
20530
20531 @item
20532 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
20533
20534 @item
20535 If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
20536 a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
20537 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
20538 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
20539 packet.
20540
20541 @end itemize
20542
20543 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
20544 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
20545
20546 @itemize @bullet
20547 @item
20548 Return value.
20549
20550 @item
20551 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
20552
20553 @item
20554 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
20555
20556 @end itemize
20557
20558 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
20559 the latest continue or step action.
20560
20561 @node The F request packet
20562 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
20563 @cindex file-i/o request packet
20564 @cindex @code{F} request packet
20565
20566 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
20567
20568 @table @samp
20569
20570 @smallexample
20571 @code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20572 @end smallexample
20573
20574 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
20575 This is just the name of the function.
20576
20577 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
20578
20579 @end table
20580
20581 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
20582 of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
20583 datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
20584 of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
20585 from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
20586 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
20587
20588 @node The F reply packet
20589 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
20590 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
20591 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
20592
20593 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
20594
20595 @table @samp
20596
20597 @smallexample
20598 @code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
20599 @end smallexample
20600
20601 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
20602
20603 @var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
20604 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
20605
20606 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
20607 case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
20608 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
20609
20610 @smallexample
20611 F0,0,C
20612 @end smallexample
20613
20614 @noindent
20615 or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
20616
20617 @smallexample
20618 F-1,4,C
20619 @end smallexample
20620
20621 @noindent
20622 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
20623
20624 @end table
20625
20626 @node Memory transfer
20627 @subsection Memory transfer
20628 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
20629
20630 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
20631 a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
20632 all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
20633 the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
20634 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
20635 data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
20636
20637 @node The Ctrl-C message
20638 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
20639 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
20640
20641 A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
20642 reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
20643 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
20644 interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
20645 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
20646 packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
20647 state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
20648 not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
20649
20650 @itemize @bullet
20651 @item
20652 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
20653
20654 @item
20655 The system call on the host has been finished.
20656
20657 @end itemize
20658
20659 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
20660 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
20661 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
20662 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
20663 system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
20664 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
20665
20666 @value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
20667 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
20668 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
20669 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
20670 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
20671 The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
20672 or the full action has been completed.
20673
20674 @node Console I/O
20675 @subsection Console I/O
20676 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
20677
20678 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
20679 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
20680 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
20681 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
20682 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
20683 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
20684 conditions is met:
20685
20686 @itemize @bullet
20687 @item
20688 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
20689 @code{read}
20690 system call is treated as finished.
20691
20692 @item
20693 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
20694 line feed.
20695
20696 @item
20697 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
20698 character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
20699
20700 @end itemize
20701
20702 If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
20703 the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
20704 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
20705 is stopped on users request.
20706
20707 @node The isatty call
20708 @subsection The isatty(3) call
20709 @cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
20710
20711 A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
20712 is implemented as it's own call inside of this protocol. It returns
20713 1 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
20714 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
20715 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
20716 needed.
20717
20718 @node The system call
20719 @subsection The system(3) call
20720 @cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
20721
20722 The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
20723 is implemented as it's own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
20724 task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
20725 call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
20726 to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
20727 in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
20728 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
20729
20730 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is refused to be called
20731 by @value{GDBN} by default. The user has to allow this call explicitly by
20732 entering
20733
20734 @table @samp
20735 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed 1
20736 @item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1}
20737 @end table
20738
20739 Disabling the @code{system} call is done by
20740
20741 @table @samp
20742 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed 0
20743 @item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 0}
20744 @end table
20745
20746 The current setting is shown by typing
20747
20748 @table @samp
20749 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
20750 @item @code{show remote system-call-allowed}
20751 @end table
20752
20753 @node List of supported calls
20754 @subsection List of supported calls
20755 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
20756
20757 @menu
20758 * open::
20759 * close::
20760 * read::
20761 * write::
20762 * lseek::
20763 * rename::
20764 * unlink::
20765 * stat/fstat::
20766 * gettimeofday::
20767 * isatty::
20768 * system::
20769 @end menu
20770
20771 @node open
20772 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
20773 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
20774
20775 @smallexample
20776 @exdent Synopsis:
20777 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
20778 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
20779
20780 @exdent Request:
20781 Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
20782 @end smallexample
20783
20784 @noindent
20785 @code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20786
20787 @table @code
20788 @item O_CREAT
20789 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
20790 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
20791 are concerned.
20792
20793 @item O_EXCL
20794 When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
20795 an error and open() fails.
20796
20797 @item O_TRUNC
20798 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
20799 writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
20800 truncated to length 0.
20801
20802 @item O_APPEND
20803 The file is opened in append mode.
20804
20805 @item O_RDONLY
20806 The file is opened for reading only.
20807
20808 @item O_WRONLY
20809 The file is opened for writing only.
20810
20811 @item O_RDWR
20812 The file is opened for reading and writing.
20813
20814 @noindent
20815 Each other bit is silently ignored.
20816
20817 @end table
20818
20819 @noindent
20820 @code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20821
20822 @table @code
20823 @item S_IRUSR
20824 User has read permission.
20825
20826 @item S_IWUSR
20827 User has write permission.
20828
20829 @item S_IRGRP
20830 Group has read permission.
20831
20832 @item S_IWGRP
20833 Group has write permission.
20834
20835 @item S_IROTH
20836 Others have read permission.
20837
20838 @item S_IWOTH
20839 Others have write permission.
20840
20841 @noindent
20842 Each other bit is silently ignored.
20843
20844 @end table
20845
20846 @smallexample
20847 @exdent Return value:
20848 open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
20849 occured.
20850
20851 @exdent Errors:
20852 @end smallexample
20853
20854 @table @code
20855 @item EEXIST
20856 pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
20857
20858 @item EISDIR
20859 pathname refers to a directory.
20860
20861 @item EACCES
20862 The requested access is not allowed.
20863
20864 @item ENAMETOOLONG
20865 pathname was too long.
20866
20867 @item ENOENT
20868 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
20869
20870 @item ENODEV
20871 pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
20872
20873 @item EROFS
20874 pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
20875 write access was requested.
20876
20877 @item EFAULT
20878 pathname is an invalid pointer value.
20879
20880 @item ENOSPC
20881 No space on device to create the file.
20882
20883 @item EMFILE
20884 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
20885
20886 @item ENFILE
20887 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
20888 has been reached.
20889
20890 @item EINTR
20891 The call was interrupted by the user.
20892 @end table
20893
20894 @node close
20895 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
20896 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
20897
20898 @smallexample
20899 @exdent Synopsis:
20900 int close(int fd);
20901
20902 @exdent Request:
20903 Fclose,fd
20904
20905 @exdent Return value:
20906 close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
20907
20908 @exdent Errors:
20909 @end smallexample
20910
20911 @table @code
20912 @item EBADF
20913 fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
20914
20915 @item EINTR
20916 The call was interrupted by the user.
20917 @end table
20918
20919 @node read
20920 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
20921 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
20922
20923 @smallexample
20924 @exdent Synopsis:
20925 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
20926
20927 @exdent Request:
20928 Fread,fd,bufptr,count
20929
20930 @exdent Return value:
20931 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
20932 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
20933 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
20934
20935 @exdent Errors:
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 @table @code
20939 @item EBADF
20940 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20941 reading.
20942
20943 @item EFAULT
20944 buf is an invalid pointer value.
20945
20946 @item EINTR
20947 The call was interrupted by the user.
20948 @end table
20949
20950 @node write
20951 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
20952 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
20953
20954 @smallexample
20955 @exdent Synopsis:
20956 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
20957
20958 @exdent Request:
20959 Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
20960
20961 @exdent Return value:
20962 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
20963 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
20964 is returned.
20965
20966 @exdent Errors:
20967 @end smallexample
20968
20969 @table @code
20970 @item EBADF
20971 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20972 writing.
20973
20974 @item EFAULT
20975 buf is an invalid pointer value.
20976
20977 @item EFBIG
20978 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
20979 host specific maximum file size allowed.
20980
20981 @item ENOSPC
20982 No space on device to write the data.
20983
20984 @item EINTR
20985 The call was interrupted by the user.
20986 @end table
20987
20988 @node lseek
20989 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
20990 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
20991
20992 @smallexample
20993 @exdent Synopsis:
20994 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
20995
20996 @exdent Request:
20997 Flseek,fd,offset,flag
20998 @end smallexample
20999
21000 @code{flag} is one of:
21001
21002 @table @code
21003 @item SEEK_SET
21004 The offset is set to offset bytes.
21005
21006 @item SEEK_CUR
21007 The offset is set to its current location plus offset
21008 bytes.
21009
21010 @item SEEK_END
21011 The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
21012 bytes.
21013 @end table
21014
21015 @smallexample
21016 @exdent Return value:
21017 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
21018 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
21019 value of -1 is returned.
21020
21021 @exdent Errors:
21022 @end smallexample
21023
21024 @table @code
21025 @item EBADF
21026 fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
21027
21028 @item ESPIPE
21029 fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
21030
21031 @item EINVAL
21032 flag is not a proper value.
21033
21034 @item EINTR
21035 The call was interrupted by the user.
21036 @end table
21037
21038 @node rename
21039 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
21040 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
21041
21042 @smallexample
21043 @exdent Synopsis:
21044 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
21045
21046 @exdent Request:
21047 Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
21048
21049 @exdent Return value:
21050 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21051
21052 @exdent Errors:
21053 @end smallexample
21054
21055 @table @code
21056 @item EISDIR
21057 newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
21058 directory.
21059
21060 @item EEXIST
21061 newpath is a non-empty directory.
21062
21063 @item EBUSY
21064 oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
21065 process.
21066
21067 @item EINVAL
21068 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
21069 of itself.
21070
21071 @item ENOTDIR
21072 A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
21073 path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
21074 and newpath exists but is not a directory.
21075
21076 @item EFAULT
21077 oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
21078
21079 @item EACCES
21080 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21081
21082 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21083
21084 oldpath or newpath was too long.
21085
21086 @item ENOENT
21087 A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
21088
21089 @item EROFS
21090 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21091
21092 @item ENOSPC
21093 The device containing the file has no room for the new
21094 directory entry.
21095
21096 @item EINTR
21097 The call was interrupted by the user.
21098 @end table
21099
21100 @node unlink
21101 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
21102 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
21103
21104 @smallexample
21105 @exdent Synopsis:
21106 int unlink(const char *pathname);
21107
21108 @exdent Request:
21109 Funlink,pathnameptr/len
21110
21111 @exdent Return value:
21112 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21113
21114 @exdent Errors:
21115 @end smallexample
21116
21117 @table @code
21118 @item EACCES
21119 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21120
21121 @item EPERM
21122 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
21123
21124 @item EBUSY
21125 The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
21126 being used by another process.
21127
21128 @item EFAULT
21129 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21130
21131 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21132 pathname was too long.
21133
21134 @item ENOENT
21135 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
21136
21137 @item ENOTDIR
21138 A component of the path is not a directory.
21139
21140 @item EROFS
21141 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21142
21143 @item EINTR
21144 The call was interrupted by the user.
21145 @end table
21146
21147 @node stat/fstat
21148 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
21149 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
21150 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
21151
21152 @smallexample
21153 @exdent Synopsis:
21154 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
21155 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
21156
21157 @exdent Request:
21158 Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
21159 Ffstat,fd,bufptr
21160
21161 @exdent Return value:
21162 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21163
21164 @exdent Errors:
21165 @end smallexample
21166
21167 @table @code
21168 @item EBADF
21169 fd is not a valid open file.
21170
21171 @item ENOENT
21172 A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
21173 path is an empty string.
21174
21175 @item ENOTDIR
21176 A component of the path is not a directory.
21177
21178 @item EFAULT
21179 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21180
21181 @item EACCES
21182 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21183
21184 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21185 pathname was too long.
21186
21187 @item EINTR
21188 The call was interrupted by the user.
21189 @end table
21190
21191 @node gettimeofday
21192 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
21193 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
21194
21195 @smallexample
21196 @exdent Synopsis:
21197 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
21198
21199 @exdent Request:
21200 Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
21201
21202 @exdent Return value:
21203 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
21204
21205 @exdent Errors:
21206 @end smallexample
21207
21208 @table @code
21209 @item EINVAL
21210 tz is a non-NULL pointer.
21211
21212 @item EFAULT
21213 tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
21214 @end table
21215
21216 @node isatty
21217 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
21218 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
21219
21220 @smallexample
21221 @exdent Synopsis:
21222 int isatty(int fd);
21223
21224 @exdent Request:
21225 Fisatty,fd
21226
21227 @exdent Return value:
21228 Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
21229
21230 @exdent Errors:
21231 @end smallexample
21232
21233 @table @code
21234 @item EINTR
21235 The call was interrupted by the user.
21236 @end table
21237
21238 @node system
21239 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
21240 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
21241
21242 @smallexample
21243 @exdent Synopsis:
21244 int system(const char *command);
21245
21246 @exdent Request:
21247 Fsystem,commandptr/len
21248
21249 @exdent Return value:
21250 The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
21251 of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
21252 command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
21253 system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
21254 In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
21255
21256 @exdent Errors:
21257 @end smallexample
21258
21259 @table @code
21260 @item EINTR
21261 The call was interrupted by the user.
21262 @end table
21263
21264 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21265 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21266 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21267
21268 @menu
21269 * Integral datatypes::
21270 * Pointer values::
21271 * struct stat::
21272 * struct timeval::
21273 @end menu
21274
21275 @node Integral datatypes
21276 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
21277 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21278
21279 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
21280
21281 @smallexample
21282 int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
21283 @end smallexample
21284
21285 @code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
21286 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
21287
21288 @code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
21289
21290 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
21291 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
21292
21293 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
21294
21295 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
21296 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
21297 byte order.
21298
21299 @node Pointer values
21300 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
21301 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
21302
21303 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
21304 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
21305 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
21306 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
21307
21308 @smallexample
21309 @code{1aaf/12}
21310 @end smallexample
21311
21312 @noindent
21313 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
21314 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
21315 the trailing null byte. Example:
21316
21317 @smallexample
21318 ``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
21319 @end smallexample
21320
21321 @noindent
21322 is transmitted as
21323
21324 @smallexample
21325 @code{123456/d}
21326 @end smallexample
21327
21328 @node struct stat
21329 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
21330 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
21331
21332 The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
21333 as follows:
21334
21335 @smallexample
21336 struct stat @{
21337 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
21338 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
21339 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
21340 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
21341 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
21342 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
21343 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
21344 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
21345 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
21346 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
21347 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
21348 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
21349 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
21350 @};
21351 @end smallexample
21352
21353 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21354 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21355 structure is of size 64 bytes.
21356
21357 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
21358 range of values.
21359
21360 @smallexample
21361 st_dev: 0 file
21362 1 console
21363
21364 st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21365
21366 st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
21367 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
21368
21369 st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21370
21371 st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21372
21373 st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21374
21375 st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
21376 These values have a host and file system dependent
21377 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
21378 don't support exact timing values.
21379 @end smallexample
21380
21381 The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
21382 responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
21383 continuing.
21384
21385 Note that due to size differences between the host and target
21386 representation of stat members, these members could eventually
21387 get truncated on the target.
21388
21389 @node struct timeval
21390 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
21391 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
21392
21393 The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
21394 is defined as follows:
21395
21396 @smallexample
21397 struct timeval @{
21398 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
21399 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
21400 @};
21401 @end smallexample
21402
21403 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21404 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21405 structure is of size 8 bytes.
21406
21407 @node Constants
21408 @subsection Constants
21409 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
21410
21411 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
21412 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
21413 values before and after the call as needed.
21414
21415 @menu
21416 * Open flags::
21417 * mode_t values::
21418 * Errno values::
21419 * Lseek flags::
21420 * Limits::
21421 @end menu
21422
21423 @node Open flags
21424 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
21425 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
21426
21427 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
21428
21429 @smallexample
21430 O_RDONLY 0x0
21431 O_WRONLY 0x1
21432 O_RDWR 0x2
21433 O_APPEND 0x8
21434 O_CREAT 0x200
21435 O_TRUNC 0x400
21436 O_EXCL 0x800
21437 @end smallexample
21438
21439 @node mode_t values
21440 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
21441 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
21442
21443 All values are given in octal representation.
21444
21445 @smallexample
21446 S_IFREG 0100000
21447 S_IFDIR 040000
21448 S_IRUSR 0400
21449 S_IWUSR 0200
21450 S_IXUSR 0100
21451 S_IRGRP 040
21452 S_IWGRP 020
21453 S_IXGRP 010
21454 S_IROTH 04
21455 S_IWOTH 02
21456 S_IXOTH 01
21457 @end smallexample
21458
21459 @node Errno values
21460 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
21461 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
21462
21463 All values are given in decimal representation.
21464
21465 @smallexample
21466 EPERM 1
21467 ENOENT 2
21468 EINTR 4
21469 EBADF 9
21470 EACCES 13
21471 EFAULT 14
21472 EBUSY 16
21473 EEXIST 17
21474 ENODEV 19
21475 ENOTDIR 20
21476 EISDIR 21
21477 EINVAL 22
21478 ENFILE 23
21479 EMFILE 24
21480 EFBIG 27
21481 ENOSPC 28
21482 ESPIPE 29
21483 EROFS 30
21484 ENAMETOOLONG 91
21485 EUNKNOWN 9999
21486 @end smallexample
21487
21488 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
21489 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
21490
21491 @node Lseek flags
21492 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
21493 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
21494
21495 @smallexample
21496 SEEK_SET 0
21497 SEEK_CUR 1
21498 SEEK_END 2
21499 @end smallexample
21500
21501 @node Limits
21502 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
21503 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
21504
21505 All values are given in decimal representation.
21506
21507 @smallexample
21508 INT_MIN -2147483648
21509 INT_MAX 2147483647
21510 UINT_MAX 4294967295
21511 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
21512 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
21513 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
21514 @end smallexample
21515
21516 @node File-I/O Examples
21517 @subsection File-I/O Examples
21518 @cindex file-i/o examples
21519
21520 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21521 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
21522
21523 @smallexample
21524 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
21525 @emph{request memory read from target}
21526 -> @code{m1234,6}
21527 <- XXXXXX
21528 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
21529 -> @code{F6}
21530 @end smallexample
21531
21532 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21533 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
21534
21535 @smallexample
21536 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21537 @emph{request memory write to target}
21538 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21539 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
21540 -> @code{F6}
21541 @end smallexample
21542
21543 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
21544 file descriptor (EBADF):
21545
21546 @smallexample
21547 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21548 -> @code{F-1,9}
21549 @end smallexample
21550
21551 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
21552 host is called:
21553
21554 @smallexample
21555 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21556 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
21557 <- @code{T02}
21558 @end smallexample
21559
21560 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
21561 host is called:
21562
21563 @smallexample
21564 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21565 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21566 <- @code{T02}
21567 @end smallexample
21568
21569 @include agentexpr.texi
21570
21571 @include gpl.texi
21572
21573 @include fdl.texi
21574
21575 @node Index
21576 @unnumbered Index
21577
21578 @printindex cp
21579
21580 @tex
21581 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
21582 % meantime:
21583 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
21584 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
21585 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
21586 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
21587 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
21588 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
21589 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
21590 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
21591 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
21592 \page\colophon
21593 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
21594 @end tex
21595
21596 @bye
This page took 0.587179 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.